xref: /linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision 79ac11393328fb1717d17c12e3c0eef0e9fa0647)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2021, 2023 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37  *
38  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39  * use restrictions.
40  */
41 
42 
43 /**
44  * DOC: Device registration
45  *
46  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48  * described below.
49  *
50  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55  * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
56  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59  *
60  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63  */
64 
65 struct wiphy;
66 
67 /*
68  * wireless hardware capability structures
69  */
70 
71 /**
72  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73  *
74  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75  *
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
80  *	channel.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
83  *	is not permitted.
84  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
85  *	is not permitted.
86  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
93  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
94  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
95  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
96  *	restrictions.
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105  *	on this channel.
106  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107  *	on this channel.
108  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109  *	on this channel.
110  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111  *	on this channel.
112  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
113  *	on this channel.
114  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
115  *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
116  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
117  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
118  *	restrictions.
119  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
120  */
121 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
123 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD		= 1<<2,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
131 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
132 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
133 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
134 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
135 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
136 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
137 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
138 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
139 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
140 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
141 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ	= 1<<19,
142 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT		= 1<<20,
143 };
144 
145 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
146 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
147 
148 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
149 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
150 
151 /**
152  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
153  *
154  * This structure describes a single channel for use
155  * with cfg80211.
156  *
157  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
158  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
159  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
160  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
161  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
162  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
163  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
164  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
165  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
166  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
167  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
168  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
169  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
170  * @orig_mag: internal use
171  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
172  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
173  *	on this channel.
174  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
175  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
176  * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
177  */
178 struct ieee80211_channel {
179 	enum nl80211_band band;
180 	u32 center_freq;
181 	u16 freq_offset;
182 	u16 hw_value;
183 	u32 flags;
184 	int max_antenna_gain;
185 	int max_power;
186 	int max_reg_power;
187 	bool beacon_found;
188 	u32 orig_flags;
189 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
190 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
191 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
192 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
193 	s8 psd;
194 };
195 
196 /**
197  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
198  *
199  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
200  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
201  * different bands/PHY modes.
202  *
203  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
204  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
205  *	with CCK rates.
206  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
207  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
208  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
209  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
210  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
211  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
212  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
213  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
214  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
215  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
216  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
217  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
218  */
219 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
220 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
221 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
222 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
223 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
224 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
225 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
226 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
227 };
228 
229 /**
230  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
231  *
232  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
233  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
234  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
235  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
236  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
237  */
238 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
239 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
240 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
241 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
242 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
243 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
244 };
245 
246 /**
247  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
248  *
249  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
250  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
251  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
252  */
253 enum ieee80211_privacy {
254 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
255 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
256 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
257 };
258 
259 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
260 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
261 
262 /**
263  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
264  *
265  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
266  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
267  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
268  * passed around.
269  *
270  * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
271  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
272  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
273  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
274  *	short preamble is used
275  */
276 struct ieee80211_rate {
277 	u32 flags;
278 	u16 bitrate;
279 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
280 };
281 
282 /**
283  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
284  *
285  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
286  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
287  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
288  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
289  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
290  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
291  *	members of the SRG
292  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
293  *	used by members of the SRG
294  */
295 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
296 	bool enable;
297 	u8 sr_ctrl;
298 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
299 	u8 min_offset;
300 	u8 max_offset;
301 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
302 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
303 };
304 
305 /**
306  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
307  *
308  * @color: the current color.
309  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
310  * @partial: define the AID equation.
311  */
312 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
313 	u8 color;
314 	bool enabled;
315 	bool partial;
316 };
317 
318 /**
319  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
320  *
321  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
322  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
323  *
324  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
325  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
326  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
327  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
328  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
329  */
330 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
331 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
332 	bool ht_supported;
333 	u8 ampdu_factor;
334 	u8 ampdu_density;
335 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
336 };
337 
338 /**
339  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
340  *
341  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
342  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
343  *
344  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
345  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
346  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
347  */
348 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
349 	bool vht_supported;
350 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
351 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
352 };
353 
354 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
355 
356 /**
357  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
358  *
359  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
360  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
361  *
362  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
363  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
364  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
365  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
366  */
367 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
368 	bool has_he;
369 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
370 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
371 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
372 };
373 
374 /**
375  * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
376  *
377  * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
378  * and NSS Set field"
379  *
380  * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
381  * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
382  * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
383  * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
384  * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
385  */
386 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
387 	union {
388 		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
389 		struct {
390 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
391 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
392 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
393 		} __packed bw;
394 	} __packed;
395 } __packed;
396 
397 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
398 
399 /**
400  * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
401  *
402  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
403  * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
404  *
405  * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
406  * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
407  * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
408  * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
409  */
410 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
411 	bool has_eht;
412 	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
413 	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
414 	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
415 };
416 
417 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
418 #ifdef __CHECKER__
419 /*
420  * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
421  * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
422  * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
423  * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
424  */
425 # define __iftd		__attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
426 #else
427 # define __iftd
428 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
429 
430 /**
431  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
432  *
433  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
434  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
435  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
436  *
437  * @types_mask: interface types mask
438  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
439  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
440  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
441  * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
442  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
443  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
444  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
445  */
446 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
447 	u16 types_mask;
448 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
449 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
450 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
451 	struct {
452 		const u8 *data;
453 		unsigned int len;
454 	} vendor_elems;
455 };
456 
457 /**
458  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
459  *
460  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
461  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
462  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
463  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
464  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
465  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
466  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
467  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
468  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
469  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
470  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
471  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
472  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
473  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
474  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
475  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
476  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
477  */
478 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
479 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
480 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
481 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
482 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
483 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
484 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
485 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
486 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
487 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
488 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
489 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
490 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
491 };
492 
493 /**
494  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
495  *
496  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
497  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
498  *
499  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
500  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
501  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
502  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
503  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
504  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
505  */
506 struct ieee80211_edmg {
507 	u8 channels;
508 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
509 };
510 
511 /**
512  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
513  *
514  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
515  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
516  *
517  * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
518  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
519  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
520  */
521 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
522 	bool s1g;
523 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
524 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
525 };
526 
527 /**
528  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
529  *
530  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
531  * is able to operate in.
532  *
533  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
534  *	in this band.
535  * @band: the band this structure represents
536  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
537  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
538  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
539  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
540  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
541  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
542  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
543  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
544  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
545  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
546  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
547  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
548  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
549  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
550  *	iftype_data).
551  */
552 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
553 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
554 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
555 	enum nl80211_band band;
556 	int n_channels;
557 	int n_bitrates;
558 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
559 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
560 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
561 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
562 	u16 n_iftype_data;
563 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
564 };
565 
566 /**
567  * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
568  * @sband: the sband to initialize
569  * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
570  * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
571  *
572  * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
573  * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
574  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
575  */
576 static inline void
577 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
578 				 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
579 				 u16 n_iftd)
580 {
581 	sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
582 	sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
583 }
584 
585 /**
586  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
587  * @sband: the sband to initialize
588  * @iftd: the iftype data array
589  */
590 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd)	\
591 	_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
592 
593 /**
594  * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
595  * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
596  * @i: iterator counter
597  * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
598  */
599 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd)				\
600 	for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i];	\
601 	     i < (sband)->n_iftype_data;					\
602 	     i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
603 
604 /**
605  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
606  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
607  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
608  *
609  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
610  */
611 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
612 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
613 				u8 iftype)
614 {
615 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
616 	int i;
617 
618 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
619 		return NULL;
620 
621 	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
622 		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
623 
624 	for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
625 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
626 			return data;
627 	}
628 
629 	return NULL;
630 }
631 
632 /**
633  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
634  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
635  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
636  *
637  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
638  */
639 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
640 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
641 			    u8 iftype)
642 {
643 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
644 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
645 
646 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
647 		return &data->he_cap;
648 
649 	return NULL;
650 }
651 
652 /**
653  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
654  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
655  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
656  *
657  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
658  */
659 static inline __le16
660 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
661 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
662 {
663 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
664 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
665 
666 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
667 		return 0;
668 
669 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
670 }
671 
672 /**
673  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
674  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
675  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
676  *
677  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
678  */
679 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
680 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
681 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
682 {
683 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
684 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
685 
686 	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
687 		return &data->eht_cap;
688 
689 	return NULL;
690 }
691 
692 /**
693  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
694  *
695  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
696  *
697  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
698  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
699  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
700  *
701  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
702  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
703  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
704  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
705  * without affecting other devices.
706  *
707  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
708  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
709  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
710  */
711 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
712 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
713 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
714 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
715 {
716 }
717 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
718 
719 
720 /*
721  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
722  */
723 
724 /**
725  * DOC: Actions and configuration
726  *
727  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
728  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
729  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
730  * operations use are described separately.
731  *
732  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
733  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
734  *
735  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
736  * in a separate chapter.
737  */
738 
739 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
740 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
741 
742 /**
743  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
744  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
745  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
746  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
747  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
748  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
749  *	determine the address as needed.
750  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
751  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
752  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
753  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
754  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
755  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
756  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
757  */
758 struct vif_params {
759 	u32 flags;
760 	int use_4addr;
761 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
762 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
763 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
764 };
765 
766 /**
767  * struct key_params - key information
768  *
769  * Information about a key
770  *
771  * @key: key material
772  * @key_len: length of key material
773  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
774  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
775  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
776  *	length given by @seq_len.
777  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
778  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
779  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
780  */
781 struct key_params {
782 	const u8 *key;
783 	const u8 *seq;
784 	int key_len;
785 	int seq_len;
786 	u16 vlan_id;
787 	u32 cipher;
788 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
789 };
790 
791 /**
792  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
793  * @chan: the (control) channel
794  * @width: channel width
795  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
796  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
797  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
798  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
799  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
800  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
801  *	parameters are ignored.
802  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
803  */
804 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
805 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
806 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
807 	u32 center_freq1;
808 	u32 center_freq2;
809 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
810 	u16 freq1_offset;
811 };
812 
813 /*
814  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
815  */
816 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
817 	struct {
818 		u32 legacy;
819 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
820 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
821 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
822 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
823 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
824 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
825 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
826 };
827 
828 
829 /**
830  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
831  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
832  *	of the peer.
833  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
834  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
835  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
836  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
837  * @retry_long: retry count value
838  * @retry_short: retry count value
839  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
840  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
841  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
842  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
843  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
844  */
845 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
846 	bool config_override;
847 	u8 tids;
848 	u64 mask;
849 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
850 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
851 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
852 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
853 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
854 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
855 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
856 };
857 
858 /**
859  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
860  * @peer: Station's MAC address
861  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
862  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
863  */
864 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
865 	const u8 *peer;
866 	u32 n_tid_conf;
867 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
868 };
869 
870 /**
871  * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
872  * @macaddr: STA MAC address
873  * @kek: FILS KEK
874  * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
875  * @snonce: STA Nonce
876  * @anonce: AP Nonce
877  */
878 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
879 	const u8 *macaddr;
880 	const u8 *kek;
881 	u8 kek_len;
882 	const u8 *snonce;
883 	const u8 *anonce;
884 };
885 
886 /**
887  * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
888  * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
889  *	addresses.
890  * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
891  *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
892  */
893 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
894 	const u8 *macaddr;
895 	bool enable;
896 };
897 
898 /**
899  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
900  * @chandef: the channel definition
901  *
902  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
903  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
904  */
905 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
906 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
907 {
908 	switch (chandef->width) {
909 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
910 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
911 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
912 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
913 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
914 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
915 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
916 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
917 	default:
918 		WARN_ON(1);
919 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
920 	}
921 }
922 
923 /**
924  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
925  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
926  * @channel: the control channel
927  * @chantype: the channel type
928  *
929  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
930  */
931 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
932 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
933 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
934 
935 /**
936  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
937  * @chandef1: first channel definition
938  * @chandef2: second channel definition
939  *
940  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
941  * identical, %false otherwise.
942  */
943 static inline bool
944 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
945 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
946 {
947 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
948 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
949 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
950 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
951 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
952 }
953 
954 /**
955  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
956  *
957  * @chandef: the channel definition
958  *
959  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
960  */
961 static inline bool
962 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
963 {
964 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
965 }
966 
967 /**
968  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
969  * @chandef1: first channel definition
970  * @chandef2: second channel definition
971  *
972  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
973  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
974  */
975 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
976 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
977 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
978 
979 /**
980  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
981  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
982  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
983  */
984 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
985 
986 /**
987  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
988  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
989  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
990  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
991  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
992  */
993 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
994 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
995 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
996 
997 /**
998  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
999  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1000  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1001  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1002  * Returns:
1003  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1004  */
1005 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1006 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1007 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1008 
1009 /**
1010  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1011  *				 can/need start CAC on such channel
1012  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1013  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1014  *
1015  * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1016  *	   one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1017  */
1018 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1019 				 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1020 
1021 /**
1022  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1023  *				   channel definition
1024  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1025  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1026  *
1027  * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1028  */
1029 unsigned int
1030 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1031 			      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1032 
1033 /**
1034  * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1035  * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1036  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1037  *
1038  * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1039  **/
1040 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1041 
1042 /**
1043  * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1044  * @width: the channel width of the channel
1045  *
1046  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1047  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1048  *
1049  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1050  */
1051 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1052 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1053 {
1054 	switch (width) {
1055 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1056 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1057 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1058 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1059 	default:
1060 		break;
1061 	}
1062 	return 0;
1063 }
1064 
1065 /**
1066  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1067  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1068  *
1069  * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1070  *
1071  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1072  */
1073 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1074 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1075 {
1076 	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1077 }
1078 
1079 /**
1080  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1081  *
1082  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1083  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1084  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1085  *
1086  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1087  *
1088  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1089  */
1090 static inline int
1091 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1092 {
1093 	switch (chandef->width) {
1094 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1095 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1096 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1097 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1098 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1099 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1100 	default:
1101 		break;
1102 	}
1103 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1104 }
1105 
1106 /**
1107  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1108  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1109  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1110  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1111  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1112  */
1113 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1114 				  unsigned long band_mask,
1115 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1116 
1117 /**
1118  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1119  *
1120  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1121  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1122  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1123  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1124  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1125  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1126  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1127  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1128  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1129  *
1130  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1131  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1132  */
1133 enum survey_info_flags {
1134 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1135 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1136 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1137 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1138 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1139 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1140 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1141 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1142 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1143 };
1144 
1145 /**
1146  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1147  *
1148  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1149  *	record to report global statistics
1150  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1151  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1152  *	optional
1153  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1154  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1155  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1156  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1157  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1158  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1159  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1160  *
1161  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1162  *
1163  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1164  * channel duty cycle etc.
1165  */
1166 struct survey_info {
1167 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1168 	u64 time;
1169 	u64 time_busy;
1170 	u64 time_ext_busy;
1171 	u64 time_rx;
1172 	u64 time_tx;
1173 	u64 time_scan;
1174 	u64 time_bss_rx;
1175 	u32 filled;
1176 	s8 noise;
1177 };
1178 
1179 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1180 
1181 /**
1182  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1183  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1184  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1185  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1186  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1187  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1188  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1189  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1190  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1191  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1192  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1193  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1194  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1195  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1196  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1197  *	protocol frames.
1198  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1199  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1200  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1201  *	port for mac80211
1202  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1203  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1204  *	offload)
1205  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1206  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1207  *
1208  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1209  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1210  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1211  *	  such a scenario.
1212  *
1213  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1214  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1215  *
1216  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1217  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1218  *
1219  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1220  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1221  */
1222 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1223 	u32 wpa_versions;
1224 	u32 cipher_group;
1225 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1226 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1227 	int n_akm_suites;
1228 	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1229 	bool control_port;
1230 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1231 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1232 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1233 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1234 	const u8 *psk;
1235 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1236 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1237 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1238 };
1239 
1240 /**
1241  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1242  *
1243  * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1244  * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1245  * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1246  */
1247 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1248 	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1249 	u8 index;
1250 	bool ema;
1251 };
1252 
1253 /**
1254  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1255  *
1256  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1257  *
1258  * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1259  * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1260  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1261  */
1262 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1263 	u8 cnt;
1264 	struct {
1265 		const u8 *data;
1266 		size_t len;
1267 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1268 };
1269 
1270 /**
1271  * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1272  *
1273  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1274  *
1275  * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1276  * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1277  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1278  */
1279 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1280 	u8 cnt;
1281 	struct {
1282 		const u8 *data;
1283 		size_t len;
1284 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1285 };
1286 
1287 /**
1288  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1289  * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1290  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1291  *	or %NULL if not changed
1292  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1293  *	or %NULL if not changed
1294  * @head_len: length of @head
1295  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1296  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1297  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1298  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1299  *	frames or %NULL
1300  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1301  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1302  *	Response frames or %NULL
1303  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1304  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1305  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1306  * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1307  * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1308  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1309  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1310  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1311  *	(measurement type 8)
1312  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1313  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1314  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1315  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1316  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1317  * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1318  *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1319  */
1320 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1321 	unsigned int link_id;
1322 
1323 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1324 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1325 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1326 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1327 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1328 	const u8 *lci;
1329 	const u8 *civicloc;
1330 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1331 	struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1332 	s8 ftm_responder;
1333 
1334 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1335 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1336 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1337 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1338 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1339 	size_t lci_len;
1340 	size_t civicloc_len;
1341 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1342 	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1343 };
1344 
1345 struct mac_address {
1346 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1347 };
1348 
1349 /**
1350  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1351  *
1352  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1353  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1354  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1355  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1356  */
1357 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1358 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1359 	int n_acl_entries;
1360 
1361 	/* Keep it last */
1362 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1363 };
1364 
1365 /**
1366  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1367  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1368  *
1369  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1370  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1371  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1372  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1373  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1374  *	frame headers.
1375  */
1376 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1377 	bool update;
1378 	u32 min_interval;
1379 	u32 max_interval;
1380 	size_t tmpl_len;
1381 	const u8 *tmpl;
1382 };
1383 
1384 /**
1385  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1386  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1387  *
1388  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1389  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1390  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1391  *	scanning
1392  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1393  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1394  */
1395 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1396 	bool update;
1397 	u32 interval;
1398 	size_t tmpl_len;
1399 	const u8 *tmpl;
1400 };
1401 
1402 /**
1403  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1404  *
1405  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1406  *
1407  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1408  * @beacon: beacon data
1409  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1410  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1411  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1412  *	user space)
1413  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1414  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1415  * @crypto: crypto settings
1416  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1417  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1418  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1419  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1420  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1421  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1422  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1423  *	MAC address based access control
1424  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1425  *	networks.
1426  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1427  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1428  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1429  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1430  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1431  * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1432  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1433  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1434  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1435  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1436  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1437  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1438  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1439  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1440  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1441  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1442  * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1443  * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1444  *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1445  *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1446  */
1447 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1448 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1449 
1450 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1451 
1452 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1453 	const u8 *ssid;
1454 	size_t ssid_len;
1455 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1456 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1457 	bool privacy;
1458 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1459 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1460 	int inactivity_timeout;
1461 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1462 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1463 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1464 	bool pbss;
1465 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1466 
1467 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1468 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1469 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1470 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1471 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1472 	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1473 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1474 	bool twt_responder;
1475 	u32 flags;
1476 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1477 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1478 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1479 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1480 	u16 punct_bitmap;
1481 };
1482 
1483 
1484 /**
1485  * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1486  *
1487  * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1488  *
1489  * @beacon: beacon data
1490  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1491  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1492  */
1493 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1494 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1495 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1496 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1497 };
1498 
1499 /**
1500  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1501  *
1502  * Used for channel switch
1503  *
1504  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1505  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1506  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1507  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1508  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1509  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1510  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1511  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1512  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1513  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1514  * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1515  *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1516  *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1517  */
1518 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1519 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1520 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1521 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1522 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1523 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1524 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1525 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1526 	bool radar_required;
1527 	bool block_tx;
1528 	u8 count;
1529 	u16 punct_bitmap;
1530 };
1531 
1532 /**
1533  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1534  *
1535  * Used for bss color change
1536  *
1537  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1538  * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1539  * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1540  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1541  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1542  * @color: the color used after the change
1543  */
1544 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1545 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1546 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1547 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1548 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1549 	u8 count;
1550 	u8 color;
1551 };
1552 
1553 /**
1554  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1555  *
1556  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1557  *
1558  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1559  *	to use for verification
1560  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1561  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1562  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1563  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1564  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1565  *	nl80211_iftype.
1566  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1567  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1568  *	the verification
1569  */
1570 struct iface_combination_params {
1571 	int num_different_channels;
1572 	u8 radar_detect;
1573 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1574 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1575 };
1576 
1577 /**
1578  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1579  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1580  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1581  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1582  *
1583  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1584  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1585  */
1586 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1587 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1588 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1589 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1590 };
1591 
1592 /**
1593  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1594  *
1595  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1596  *
1597  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1598  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1599  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1600  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1601  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1602  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1603  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1604  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1605  *	per peer TPC.
1606  */
1607 struct sta_txpwr {
1608 	s16 power;
1609 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1610 };
1611 
1612 /**
1613  * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1614  *
1615  * Used to change and create a new link station.
1616  *
1617  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1618  * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1619  * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1620  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1621  *	(or NULL for no change)
1622  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1623  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1624  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1625  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1626  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1627  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1628  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1629  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1630  * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1631  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1632  * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1633  * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1634  */
1635 struct link_station_parameters {
1636 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1637 	int link_id;
1638 	const u8 *link_mac;
1639 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1640 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1641 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1642 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1643 	u8 opmode_notif;
1644 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1645 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1646 	u8 he_capa_len;
1647 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1648 	bool txpwr_set;
1649 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1650 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1651 	u8 eht_capa_len;
1652 };
1653 
1654 /**
1655  * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1656  *
1657  * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1658  *
1659  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1660  * @link_id: the link id
1661  */
1662 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1663 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1664 	u32 link_id;
1665 };
1666 
1667 /**
1668  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1669  *
1670  * Used to change and create a new station.
1671  *
1672  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1673  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1674  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1675  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1676  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1677  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1678  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1679  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1680  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1681  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1682  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1683  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1684  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1685  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1686  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1687  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1688  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1689  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1690  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1691  *	to unknown)
1692  * @capability: station capability
1693  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1694  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1695  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1696  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1697  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1698  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1699  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1700  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1701  * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1702  */
1703 struct station_parameters {
1704 	struct net_device *vlan;
1705 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1706 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1707 	int listen_interval;
1708 	u16 aid;
1709 	u16 vlan_id;
1710 	u16 peer_aid;
1711 	u8 plink_action;
1712 	u8 plink_state;
1713 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1714 	u8 max_sp;
1715 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1716 	u16 capability;
1717 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1718 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1719 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1720 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1721 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1722 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1723 	int support_p2p_ps;
1724 	u16 airtime_weight;
1725 	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1726 };
1727 
1728 /**
1729  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1730  *
1731  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1732  *
1733  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1734  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1735  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1736  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1737  */
1738 struct station_del_parameters {
1739 	const u8 *mac;
1740 	u8 subtype;
1741 	u16 reason_code;
1742 };
1743 
1744 /**
1745  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1746  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1747  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1748  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1749  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1750  *	the AP MLME in the device
1751  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1752  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1753  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1754  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1755  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1756  *	supported/used)
1757  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1758  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1759  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1760  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1761  */
1762 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1763 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1764 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1765 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1766 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1767 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1768 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1769 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1770 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1771 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1772 };
1773 
1774 /**
1775  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1776  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1777  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1778  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1779  *
1780  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1781  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1782  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1783  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1784  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1785  */
1786 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1787 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1788 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1789 
1790 /**
1791  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1792  *
1793  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1794  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1795  *
1796  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1797  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1798  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1799  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1800  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1801  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1802  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1803  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1804  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1805  */
1806 enum rate_info_flags {
1807 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1808 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1809 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1810 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1811 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1812 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1813 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1814 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1815 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8),
1816 };
1817 
1818 /**
1819  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1820  *
1821  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1822  *
1823  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1824  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1825  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1826  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1827  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1828  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1829  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1830  * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1831  * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1832  * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1833  * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1834  * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1835  * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1836  * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1837  */
1838 enum rate_info_bw {
1839 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1840 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1841 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1842 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1843 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1844 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1845 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1846 	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1847 	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1848 	RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1849 	RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1850 	RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1851 	RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1852 	RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1853 };
1854 
1855 /**
1856  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1857  *
1858  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1859  *
1860  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1861  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1862  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1863  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1864  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1865  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1866  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1867  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1868  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1869  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1870  * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1871  * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1872  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1873  */
1874 struct rate_info {
1875 	u16 flags;
1876 	u16 legacy;
1877 	u8 mcs;
1878 	u8 nss;
1879 	u8 bw;
1880 	u8 he_gi;
1881 	u8 he_dcm;
1882 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1883 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1884 	u8 eht_gi;
1885 	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1886 };
1887 
1888 /**
1889  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1890  *
1891  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1892  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1893  *
1894  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1895  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1896  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1897  */
1898 enum bss_param_flags {
1899 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1900 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1901 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1902 };
1903 
1904 /**
1905  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1906  *
1907  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1908  *
1909  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1910  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1911  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1912  */
1913 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1914 	u8 flags;
1915 	u8 dtim_period;
1916 	u16 beacon_interval;
1917 };
1918 
1919 /**
1920  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1921  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1922  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1923  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1924  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1925  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1926  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1927  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1928  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1929  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1930  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1931  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1932  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1933  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1934  */
1935 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1936 	u32 filled;
1937 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1938 	u32 backlog_packets;
1939 	u32 flows;
1940 	u32 drops;
1941 	u32 ecn_marks;
1942 	u32 overlimit;
1943 	u32 overmemory;
1944 	u32 collisions;
1945 	u32 tx_bytes;
1946 	u32 tx_packets;
1947 	u32 max_flows;
1948 };
1949 
1950 /**
1951  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1952  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1953  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1954  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1955  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1956  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1957  *	transmitted MSDUs
1958  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1959  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1960  */
1961 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1962 	u32 filled;
1963 	u64 rx_msdu;
1964 	u64 tx_msdu;
1965 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1966 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1967 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1968 };
1969 
1970 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1971 
1972 /**
1973  * struct station_info - station information
1974  *
1975  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1976  *
1977  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1978  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1979  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1980  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1981  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1982  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1983  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1984  * @llid: mesh local link id
1985  * @plid: mesh peer link id
1986  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1987  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1988  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1989  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1990  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1991  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1992  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1993  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1994  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1995  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1996  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1997  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1998  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1999  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2000  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
2001  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2002  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2003  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
2004  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2005  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2006  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2007  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2008  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2009  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2010  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2011  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2012  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2013  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2014  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2015  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2016  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2017  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2018  *	towards this station.
2019  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2020  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2021  *	from this peer
2022  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2023  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2024  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2025  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2026  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2027  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2028  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2029  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2030  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2031  *	been sent.
2032  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2033  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2034  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2035  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2036  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2037  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2038  * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2039  *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2040  *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2041  *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2042  *	dump_station() callbacks.
2043  * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2044  *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2045  *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2046  * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2047  *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2048  * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2049  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2050  *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2051  *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2052  *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2053  *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2054  *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2055  * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2056  */
2057 struct station_info {
2058 	u64 filled;
2059 	u32 connected_time;
2060 	u32 inactive_time;
2061 	u64 assoc_at;
2062 	u64 rx_bytes;
2063 	u64 tx_bytes;
2064 	u16 llid;
2065 	u16 plid;
2066 	u8 plink_state;
2067 	s8 signal;
2068 	s8 signal_avg;
2069 
2070 	u8 chains;
2071 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2072 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2073 
2074 	struct rate_info txrate;
2075 	struct rate_info rxrate;
2076 	u32 rx_packets;
2077 	u32 tx_packets;
2078 	u32 tx_retries;
2079 	u32 tx_failed;
2080 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2081 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2082 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2083 
2084 	int generation;
2085 
2086 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2087 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2088 
2089 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
2090 	s64 t_offset;
2091 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2092 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2093 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2094 
2095 	u32 expected_throughput;
2096 
2097 	u64 tx_duration;
2098 	u64 rx_duration;
2099 	u64 rx_beacon;
2100 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2101 	u8 connected_to_gate;
2102 
2103 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2104 	s8 ack_signal;
2105 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
2106 
2107 	u16 airtime_weight;
2108 
2109 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2110 	u32 fcs_err_count;
2111 
2112 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
2113 
2114 	u8 connected_to_as;
2115 
2116 	bool mlo_params_valid;
2117 	u8 assoc_link_id;
2118 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2119 	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2120 	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2121 };
2122 
2123 /**
2124  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2125  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2126  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2127  */
2128 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2129 	s32 power;
2130 	u32 freq_range_index;
2131 };
2132 
2133 /**
2134  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2135  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2136  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2137  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2138  */
2139 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2140 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2141 	u32 num_sub_specs;
2142 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
2143 };
2144 
2145 
2146 /**
2147  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2148  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2149  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2150  */
2151 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2152 	u32 start_freq;
2153 	u32 end_freq;
2154 };
2155 
2156 /**
2157  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2158  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2159  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2160  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2161  *
2162  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2163  * range to small ones and then append them.
2164  */
2165 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2166 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2167 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2168 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2169 };
2170 
2171 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2172 /**
2173  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2174  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2175  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2176  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2177  *
2178  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2179  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2180  * considered undefined.
2181  */
2182 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2183 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2184 #else
2185 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2186 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2187 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2188 {
2189 	return -ENOENT;
2190 }
2191 #endif
2192 
2193 /**
2194  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2195  *
2196  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2197  * according to the nl80211 flags.
2198  *
2199  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2200  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2201  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2202  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2203  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2204  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2205  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2206  */
2207 enum monitor_flags {
2208 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
2209 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
2210 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
2211 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
2212 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
2213 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
2214 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
2215 };
2216 
2217 /**
2218  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2219  *
2220  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2221  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2222  *
2223  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2224  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2225  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2226  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2227  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2228  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2229  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2230  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2231  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2232  */
2233 enum mpath_info_flags {
2234 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2235 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2236 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2237 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2238 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2239 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2240 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2241 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2242 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2243 };
2244 
2245 /**
2246  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2247  *
2248  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2249  *
2250  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2251  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2252  * @sn: target sequence number
2253  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2254  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2255  * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2256  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2257  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2258  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2259  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2260  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2261  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2262  * @hop_count: hops to destination
2263  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2264  */
2265 struct mpath_info {
2266 	u32 filled;
2267 	u32 frame_qlen;
2268 	u32 sn;
2269 	u32 metric;
2270 	u32 exptime;
2271 	u32 discovery_timeout;
2272 	u8 discovery_retries;
2273 	u8 flags;
2274 	u8 hop_count;
2275 	u32 path_change_count;
2276 
2277 	int generation;
2278 };
2279 
2280 /**
2281  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2282  *
2283  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2284  *
2285  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2286  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2287  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2288  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2289  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2290  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2291  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2292  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2293  *	(or NULL for no change)
2294  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2295  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2296  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2297  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2298  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2299  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2300  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2301  */
2302 struct bss_parameters {
2303 	int link_id;
2304 	int use_cts_prot;
2305 	int use_short_preamble;
2306 	int use_short_slot_time;
2307 	const u8 *basic_rates;
2308 	u8 basic_rates_len;
2309 	int ap_isolate;
2310 	int ht_opmode;
2311 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2312 };
2313 
2314 /**
2315  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2316  *
2317  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2318  *
2319  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2320  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2321  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2322  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2323  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2324  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2325  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2326  *	mesh interface
2327  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2328  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2329  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2330  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2331  *	elements
2332  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2333  *	detect compatible mesh peers
2334  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2335  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2336  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2337  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2338  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2339  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2340  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2341  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2342  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2343  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2344  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2345  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2346  *	element
2347  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2348  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2349  *	element
2350  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2351  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2352  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2353  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2354  *	announcements are transmitted
2355  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2356  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2357  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2358  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2359  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2360  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2361  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2362  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2363  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2364  *	station to establish a peer link
2365  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2366  *
2367  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2368  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2369  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2370  *
2371  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2372  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2373  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2374  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2375  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2376  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2377  *	setting for new peer links.
2378  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2379  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2380  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2381  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2382  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2383  * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2384  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2385  *	in the mesh formation field.
2386  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2387  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2388  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2389  *      in the mesh path table
2390  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2391  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2392  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2393  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2394  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2395  */
2396 struct mesh_config {
2397 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2398 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2399 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2400 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2401 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2402 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2403 	u8 element_ttl;
2404 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2405 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2406 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2407 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2408 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2409 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2410 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2411 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2412 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2413 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2414 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2415 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2416 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2417 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2418 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2419 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2420 	u16 ht_opmode;
2421 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2422 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2423 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2424 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2425 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2426 	u32 plink_timeout;
2427 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2428 };
2429 
2430 /**
2431  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2432  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2433  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2434  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2435  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2436  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2437  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2438  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2439  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2440  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2441  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2442  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2443  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2444  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2445  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2446  * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2447  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2448  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2449  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2450  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2451  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2452  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2453  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2454  *
2455  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2456  */
2457 struct mesh_setup {
2458 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2459 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2460 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2461 	u8 sync_method;
2462 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2463 	u8 path_metric;
2464 	u8 auth_id;
2465 	const u8 *ie;
2466 	u8 ie_len;
2467 	bool is_authenticated;
2468 	bool is_secure;
2469 	bool user_mpm;
2470 	u8 dtim_period;
2471 	u16 beacon_interval;
2472 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2473 	u32 basic_rates;
2474 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2475 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2476 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2477 };
2478 
2479 /**
2480  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2481  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2482  *
2483  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2484  */
2485 struct ocb_setup {
2486 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2487 };
2488 
2489 /**
2490  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2491  * @ac: AC identifier
2492  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2493  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2494  *	1..32767]
2495  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2496  *	1..32767]
2497  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2498  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2499  */
2500 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2501 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2502 	u16 txop;
2503 	u16 cwmin;
2504 	u16 cwmax;
2505 	u8 aifs;
2506 	int link_id;
2507 };
2508 
2509 /**
2510  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2511  *
2512  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2513  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2514  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2515  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2516  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2517  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2518  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2519  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2520  * in the wiphy structure.
2521  *
2522  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2523  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2524  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2525  *
2526  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2527  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2528  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2529  * to userspace.
2530  */
2531 
2532 /**
2533  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2534  * @ssid: the SSID
2535  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2536  */
2537 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2538 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2539 	u8 ssid_len;
2540 };
2541 
2542 /**
2543  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2544  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2545  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2546  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2547  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2548  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2549  *	userspace will be notified of that
2550  */
2551 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2552 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2553 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2554 	bool aborted;
2555 };
2556 
2557 /**
2558  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2559  *
2560  * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2561  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2562  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2563  *	 which the above info relvant to
2564  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2565  * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2566  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2567  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2568  * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2569  */
2570 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2571 	u32 short_ssid;
2572 	u32 channel_idx;
2573 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2574 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2575 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2576 	bool psc_no_listen;
2577 	s8 psd_20;
2578 };
2579 
2580 /**
2581  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2582  *
2583  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2584  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2585  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2586  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2587  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2588  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2589  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2590  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2591  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2592  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2593  *	%duration field.
2594  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2595  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2596  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2597  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2598  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2599  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2600  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2601  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2602  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2603  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2604  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2605  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2606  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2607  *	true if this is the second scan request
2608  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2609  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2610  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2611  * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2612  *      used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2613  */
2614 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2615 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2616 	int n_ssids;
2617 	u32 n_channels;
2618 	const u8 *ie;
2619 	size_t ie_len;
2620 	u16 duration;
2621 	bool duration_mandatory;
2622 	u32 flags;
2623 
2624 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2625 
2626 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2627 
2628 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2629 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2630 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2631 
2632 	/* internal */
2633 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2634 	unsigned long scan_start;
2635 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2636 	bool notified;
2637 	bool no_cck;
2638 	bool scan_6ghz;
2639 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2640 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2641 	s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2642 
2643 	/* keep last */
2644 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2645 };
2646 
2647 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2648 {
2649 	int i;
2650 
2651 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2652 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2653 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2654 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2655 	}
2656 }
2657 
2658 /**
2659  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2660  *
2661  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2662  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2663  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2664  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2665  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2666  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2667  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertise this support
2668  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2669  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2670  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2671  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2672  *	corresponding matchset.
2673  */
2674 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2675 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2676 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2677 	s32 rssi_thold;
2678 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2679 };
2680 
2681 /**
2682  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2683  *
2684  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2685  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2686  *	infinite loop.
2687  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2688  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2689  */
2690 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2691 	u32 interval;
2692 	u32 iterations;
2693 };
2694 
2695 /**
2696  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2697  *
2698  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2699  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2700  */
2701 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2702 	enum nl80211_band band;
2703 	s8 delta;
2704 };
2705 
2706 /**
2707  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2708  *
2709  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2710  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2711  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2712  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2713  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2714  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2715  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2716  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2717  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2718  *	(others are filtered out).
2719  *	If omitted, all results are passed.
2720  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2721  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2722  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2723  * @dev: the interface
2724  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2725  * @channels: channels to scan
2726  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2727  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2728  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2729  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2730  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2731  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2732  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2733  *	index must be executed first.
2734  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2735  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2736  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2737  *	owned by a particular socket)
2738  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2739  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2740  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2741  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2742  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2743  *	supported.
2744  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2745  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2746  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2747  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2748  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2749  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2750  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2751  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2752  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2753  *	comparisons.
2754  */
2755 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2756 	u64 reqid;
2757 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2758 	int n_ssids;
2759 	u32 n_channels;
2760 	const u8 *ie;
2761 	size_t ie_len;
2762 	u32 flags;
2763 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2764 	int n_match_sets;
2765 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2766 	u32 delay;
2767 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2768 	int n_scan_plans;
2769 
2770 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2771 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2772 
2773 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2774 	s8 relative_rssi;
2775 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2776 
2777 	/* internal */
2778 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2779 	struct net_device *dev;
2780 	unsigned long scan_start;
2781 	bool report_results;
2782 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2783 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2784 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2785 	struct list_head list;
2786 
2787 	/* keep last */
2788 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2789 };
2790 
2791 /**
2792  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2793  *
2794  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2795  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2796  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2797  */
2798 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2799 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2800 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2801 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2802 };
2803 
2804 /**
2805  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2806  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2807  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2808  *	signal type
2809  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2810  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2811  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2812  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2813  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2814  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2815  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2816  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2817  *	by %parent_bssid.
2818  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2819  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2820  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2821  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2822  * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2823  */
2824 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2825 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2826 	s32 signal;
2827 	u64 boottime_ns;
2828 	u64 parent_tsf;
2829 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2830 	u8 chains;
2831 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2832 
2833 	void *drv_data;
2834 };
2835 
2836 /**
2837  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2838  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2839  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2840  * @len: length of the IEs
2841  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2842  * @data: IE data
2843  */
2844 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2845 	u64 tsf;
2846 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2847 	int len;
2848 	bool from_beacon;
2849 	u8 data[];
2850 };
2851 
2852 /**
2853  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2854  *
2855  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2856  * for use in scan results and similar.
2857  *
2858  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2859  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2860  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2861  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2862  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2863  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2864  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2865  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2866  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2867  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2868  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2869  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2870  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2871  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2872  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2873  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2874  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2875  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2876  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2877  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2878  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2879  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2880  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2881  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2882  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2883  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2884  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2885  */
2886 struct cfg80211_bss {
2887 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2888 
2889 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2890 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2891 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2892 
2893 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2894 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2895 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2896 
2897 	s32 signal;
2898 
2899 	u16 beacon_interval;
2900 	u16 capability;
2901 
2902 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2903 	u8 chains;
2904 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2905 
2906 	u8 bssid_index;
2907 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2908 
2909 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2910 };
2911 
2912 /**
2913  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2914  * @bss: the bss to search
2915  * @id: the element ID
2916  *
2917  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2918  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2919  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2920  */
2921 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2922 
2923 /**
2924  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2925  * @bss: the bss to search
2926  * @id: the element ID
2927  *
2928  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2929  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2930  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2931  */
2932 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2933 {
2934 	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2935 }
2936 
2937 
2938 /**
2939  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2940  *
2941  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2942  * authentication.
2943  *
2944  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2945  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2946  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2947  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2948  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2949  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2950  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2951  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2952  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2953  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2954  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2955  *	transaction sequence number field.
2956  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2957  * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
2958  *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
2959  *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
2960  *	given an MLD address) by the driver
2961  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
2962  *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
2963  */
2964 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2965 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2966 	const u8 *ie;
2967 	size_t ie_len;
2968 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2969 	const u8 *key;
2970 	u8 key_len;
2971 	s8 key_idx;
2972 	const u8 *auth_data;
2973 	size_t auth_data_len;
2974 	s8 link_id;
2975 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
2976 };
2977 
2978 /**
2979  * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
2980  * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
2981  *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
2982  * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
2983  * @elems_len: length of the elements
2984  * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
2985  *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
2986  * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
2987  *	operation as a whole must fail.
2988  */
2989 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
2990 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2991 	const u8 *elems;
2992 	size_t elems_len;
2993 	bool disabled;
2994 	int error;
2995 };
2996 
2997 /**
2998  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2999  *
3000  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
3001  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
3002  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3003  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3004  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3005  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3006  *	request (connect callback).
3007  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
3008  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
3009  * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3010  *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3011  *	flag is not set.
3012  */
3013 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3014 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
3015 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
3016 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
3017 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
3018 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
3019 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
3020 	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
3021 };
3022 
3023 /**
3024  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3025  *
3026  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3027  * (re)association.
3028  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3029  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3030  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3031  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3032  *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3033  *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3034  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3035  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3036  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3037  * @crypto: crypto settings
3038  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3039  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3040  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3041  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3042  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3043  *	frame.
3044  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3045  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3046  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3047  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3048  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3049  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3050  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3051  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
3052  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3053  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3054  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3055  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3056  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3057  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3058  * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3059  * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3060  *	the link on which the association request should be sent
3061  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3062  *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
3063  */
3064 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3065 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3066 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3067 	size_t ie_len;
3068 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3069 	bool use_mfp;
3070 	u32 flags;
3071 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3072 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3073 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3074 	const u8 *fils_kek;
3075 	size_t fils_kek_len;
3076 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
3077 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3078 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3079 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3080 	s8 link_id;
3081 };
3082 
3083 /**
3084  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3085  *
3086  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3087  * deauthentication.
3088  *
3089  * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3090  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3091  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3092  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3093  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3094  *	do not set a deauth frame
3095  */
3096 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3097 	const u8 *bssid;
3098 	const u8 *ie;
3099 	size_t ie_len;
3100 	u16 reason_code;
3101 	bool local_state_change;
3102 };
3103 
3104 /**
3105  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3106  *
3107  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3108  * disassociation.
3109  *
3110  * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3111  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3112  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3113  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3114  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3115  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3116  */
3117 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3118 	const u8 *ap_addr;
3119 	const u8 *ie;
3120 	size_t ie_len;
3121 	u16 reason_code;
3122 	bool local_state_change;
3123 };
3124 
3125 /**
3126  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3127  *
3128  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3129  * method.
3130  *
3131  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3132  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3133  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3134  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3135  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3136  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3137  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3138  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3139  * @ie_len: length of that
3140  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3141  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3142  *	after joining
3143  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3144  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3145  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3146  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3147  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3148  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3149  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3150  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3151  *	to operate on DFS channels.
3152  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3153  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3154  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3155  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3156  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3157  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3158  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3159  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3160  */
3161 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3162 	const u8 *ssid;
3163 	const u8 *bssid;
3164 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3165 	const u8 *ie;
3166 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3167 	u16 beacon_interval;
3168 	u32 basic_rates;
3169 	bool channel_fixed;
3170 	bool privacy;
3171 	bool control_port;
3172 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3173 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3174 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3175 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3176 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3177 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3178 	int wep_tx_key;
3179 };
3180 
3181 /**
3182  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3183  *
3184  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3185  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3186  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3187  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3188  */
3189 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3190 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3191 	union {
3192 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3193 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3194 	} param;
3195 };
3196 
3197 /**
3198  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3199  *
3200  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3201  * authentication and association.
3202  *
3203  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3204  *	on scan results)
3205  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3206  *	%NULL if not specified
3207  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3208  *	results)
3209  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3210  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3211  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3212  *	to use.
3213  * @ssid: SSID
3214  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3215  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3216  * @ie: IEs for association request
3217  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3218  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3219  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3220  * @crypto: crypto settings
3221  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3222  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3223  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3224  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3225  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3226  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3227  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3228  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3229  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3230  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3231  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3232  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3233  *	networks.
3234  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3235  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3236  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3237  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3238  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3239  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3240  *	frame.
3241  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3242  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3243  *	data IE.
3244  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3245  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3246  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3247  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3248  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3249  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3250  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3251  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3252  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3253  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3254  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3255  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3256  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3257  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3258  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3259  */
3260 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3261 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3262 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3263 	const u8 *bssid;
3264 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3265 	const u8 *ssid;
3266 	size_t ssid_len;
3267 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3268 	const u8 *ie;
3269 	size_t ie_len;
3270 	bool privacy;
3271 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3272 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3273 	const u8 *key;
3274 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3275 	u32 flags;
3276 	int bg_scan_period;
3277 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3278 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3279 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3280 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3281 	bool pbss;
3282 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3283 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3284 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3285 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3286 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3287 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3288 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3289 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3290 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3291 	bool want_1x;
3292 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3293 };
3294 
3295 /**
3296  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3297  *
3298  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3299  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3300  *
3301  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3302  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3303  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3304  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3305  */
3306 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3307 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3308 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3309 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3310 };
3311 
3312 /**
3313  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3314  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3315  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3316  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3317  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3318  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3319  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3320  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3321  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3322  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3323  */
3324 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3325 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
3326 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
3327 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
3328 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
3329 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
3330 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
3331 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
3332 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
3333 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
3334 };
3335 
3336 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3337 
3338 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3339 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3340 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3341 
3342 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3343 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3344 
3345 /**
3346  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3347  *
3348  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3349  * caching.
3350  *
3351  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3352  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3353  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3354  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3355  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3356  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3357  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3358  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3359  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3360  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3361  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3362  *	%NULL).
3363  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3364  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3365  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3366  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3367  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3368  *	used for it expires.
3369  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3370  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3371  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3372  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3373  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3374  */
3375 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3376 	const u8 *bssid;
3377 	const u8 *pmkid;
3378 	const u8 *pmk;
3379 	size_t pmk_len;
3380 	const u8 *ssid;
3381 	size_t ssid_len;
3382 	const u8 *cache_id;
3383 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3384 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3385 };
3386 
3387 /**
3388  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3389  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3390  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3391  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3392  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3393  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3394  *
3395  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3396  * memory, free @mask only!
3397  */
3398 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3399 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3400 	int pattern_len;
3401 	int pkt_offset;
3402 };
3403 
3404 /**
3405  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3406  *
3407  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3408  * @src: source IP address
3409  * @dst: destination IP address
3410  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3411  * @src_port: source port
3412  * @dst_port: destination port
3413  * @payload_len: data payload length
3414  * @payload: data payload buffer
3415  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3416  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3417  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3418  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3419  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3420  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3421  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3422  */
3423 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3424 	struct socket *sock;
3425 	__be32 src, dst;
3426 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3427 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3428 	int payload_len;
3429 	const u8 *payload;
3430 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3431 	u32 data_interval;
3432 	u32 wake_len;
3433 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3434 	u32 tokens_size;
3435 	/* must be last, variable member */
3436 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3437 };
3438 
3439 /**
3440  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3441  *
3442  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3443  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3444  *	operating as normal during suspend
3445  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3446  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3447  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3448  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3449  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3450  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3451  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3452  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3453  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3454  *	NULL if not configured.
3455  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3456  */
3457 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3458 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3459 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3460 	     rfkill_release;
3461 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3462 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3463 	int n_patterns;
3464 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3465 };
3466 
3467 /**
3468  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3469  *
3470  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3471  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3472  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3473  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3474  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3475  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3476  */
3477 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3478 	int delay;
3479 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3480 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3481 	int n_patterns;
3482 };
3483 
3484 /**
3485  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3486  *
3487  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3488  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3489  * @n_rules: number of rules
3490  */
3491 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3492 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3493 	int n_rules;
3494 };
3495 
3496 /**
3497  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3498  *
3499  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3500  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3501  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3502  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3503  *	occurred (in MHz)
3504  */
3505 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3506 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3507 	int n_channels;
3508 	u32 channels[];
3509 };
3510 
3511 /**
3512  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3513  *
3514  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3515  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3516  *	match information.
3517  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3518  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3519  */
3520 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3521 	int n_matches;
3522 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3523 };
3524 
3525 /**
3526  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3527  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3528  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3529  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3530  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3531  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3532  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3533  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3534  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3535  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3536  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3537  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3538  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3539  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3540  *	it is.
3541  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3542  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3543  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3544  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3545  */
3546 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3547 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3548 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3549 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3550 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3551 	s32 pattern_idx;
3552 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3553 	const void *packet;
3554 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3555 };
3556 
3557 /**
3558  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3559  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3560  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3561  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3562  * @kek_len: length of kek
3563  * @kck_len: length of kck
3564  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3565  */
3566 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3567 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3568 	u32 akm;
3569 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3570 };
3571 
3572 /**
3573  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3574  *
3575  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3576  *
3577  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3578  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3579  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3580  */
3581 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3582 	u16 md;
3583 	const u8 *ie;
3584 	size_t ie_len;
3585 };
3586 
3587 /**
3588  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3589  *
3590  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3591  *
3592  * @chan: channel to use
3593  * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3594  * @wait: duration for ROC
3595  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3596  * @len: buffer length
3597  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3598  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3599  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3600  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3601  * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3602  *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3603  *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3604  */
3605 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3606 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3607 	bool offchan;
3608 	unsigned int wait;
3609 	const u8 *buf;
3610 	size_t len;
3611 	bool no_cck;
3612 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3613 	int n_csa_offsets;
3614 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3615 	int link_id;
3616 };
3617 
3618 /**
3619  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3620  *
3621  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3622  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3623  */
3624 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3625 	u8 dscp;
3626 	u8 up;
3627 };
3628 
3629 /**
3630  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3631  *
3632  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3633  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3634  */
3635 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3636 	u8 low;
3637 	u8 high;
3638 };
3639 
3640 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3641 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3642 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3643 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3644 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3645 
3646 /**
3647  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3648  *
3649  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3650  *
3651  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3652  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3653  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3654  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3655  */
3656 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3657 	u8 num_des;
3658 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3659 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3660 };
3661 
3662 /**
3663  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3664  *
3665  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3666  *
3667  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3668  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3669  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3670  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3671  */
3672 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3673 	u8 master_pref;
3674 	u8 bands;
3675 };
3676 
3677 /**
3678  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3679  * configuration
3680  *
3681  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3682  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3683  */
3684 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3685 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3686 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3687 };
3688 
3689 /**
3690  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3691  *
3692  * @filter: the content of the filter
3693  * @len: the length of the filter
3694  */
3695 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3696 	const u8 *filter;
3697 	u8 len;
3698 };
3699 
3700 /**
3701  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3702  *
3703  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3704  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3705  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3706  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3707  *	implementation specific.
3708  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3709  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3710  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3711  * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3712  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3713  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3714  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3715  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3716  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3717  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3718  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3719  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3720  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3721  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3722  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3723  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3724  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3725  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3726  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3727  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3728  */
3729 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3730 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3731 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3732 	u8 publish_type;
3733 	bool close_range;
3734 	bool publish_bcast;
3735 	bool subscribe_active;
3736 	u8 followup_id;
3737 	u8 followup_reqid;
3738 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3739 	u32 ttl;
3740 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3741 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3742 	bool srf_include;
3743 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3744 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3745 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3746 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3747 	int srf_num_macs;
3748 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3749 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3750 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3751 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3752 	u8 instance_id;
3753 	u64 cookie;
3754 };
3755 
3756 /**
3757  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3758  *
3759  * @aa: authenticator address
3760  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3761  * @pmk: the PMK material
3762  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3763  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3764  *	holds PMK-R0.
3765  */
3766 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3767 	const u8 *aa;
3768 	u8 pmk_len;
3769 	const u8 *pmk;
3770 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3771 };
3772 
3773 /**
3774  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3775  *
3776  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3777  *
3778  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3779  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3780  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3781  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3782  *	authentication response command interface.
3783  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3784  *	authentication response command interface.
3785  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3786  *	authentication request event interface.
3787  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3788  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3789  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3790  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3791  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3792  * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3793  *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3794  *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3795  *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3796  *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3797  *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3798  *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3799  *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3800  *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3801  *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3802  *	chosen for the authentication.
3803  */
3804 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3805 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3806 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3807 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3808 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3809 	u16 status;
3810 	const u8 *pmkid;
3811 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3812 };
3813 
3814 /**
3815  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3816  *
3817  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3818  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3819  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3820  *	answered
3821  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3822  *	successfully answered
3823  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3824  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3825  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3826  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3827  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3828  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3829  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3830  *	the responder
3831  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3832  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3833  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3834  */
3835 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3836 	u32 filled;
3837 	u32 success_num;
3838 	u32 partial_num;
3839 	u32 failed_num;
3840 	u32 asap_num;
3841 	u32 non_asap_num;
3842 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3843 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3844 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3845 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3846 };
3847 
3848 /**
3849  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3850  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3851  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3852  *	reason than just "failure"
3853  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3854  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3855  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3856  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3857  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3858  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3859  *	by the responder
3860  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3861  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3862  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3863  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3864  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3865  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3866  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3867  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3868  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3869  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3870  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3871  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3872  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3873  *	the square root of the variance)
3874  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3875  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3876  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3877  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3878  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3879  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3880  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3881  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3882  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3883  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3884  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3885  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3886  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3887  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3888  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3889  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3890  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3891  */
3892 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3893 	const u8 *lci;
3894 	const u8 *civicloc;
3895 	unsigned int lci_len;
3896 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3897 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3898 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3899 	s16 burst_index;
3900 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3901 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3902 	u8 burst_duration;
3903 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3904 	s32 rssi_avg;
3905 	s32 rssi_spread;
3906 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3907 	s64 rtt_avg;
3908 	s64 rtt_variance;
3909 	s64 rtt_spread;
3910 	s64 dist_avg;
3911 	s64 dist_variance;
3912 	s64 dist_spread;
3913 
3914 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3915 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3916 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3917 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3918 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3919 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3920 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3921 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3922 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3923 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3924 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3925 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3926 };
3927 
3928 /**
3929  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3930  * @addr: address of the peer
3931  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3932  *	measurement was made)
3933  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3934  * @status: status of the measurement
3935  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3936  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3937  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3938  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3939  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3940  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3941  * @ftm: FTM result
3942  */
3943 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3944 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3945 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3946 
3947 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3948 
3949 	u8 final:1,
3950 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3951 
3952 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3953 
3954 	union {
3955 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3956 	};
3957 };
3958 
3959 /**
3960  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3961  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3962  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3963  * @burst_period: burst period to use
3964  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3965  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3966  * @burst_duration: burst duration
3967  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3968  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3969  * @request_lci: request LCI information
3970  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3971  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3972  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3973  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3974  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3975  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3976  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3977  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
3978  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
3979  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
3980  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
3981  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
3982  *
3983  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3984  */
3985 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3986 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3987 	u16 burst_period;
3988 	u8 requested:1,
3989 	   asap:1,
3990 	   request_lci:1,
3991 	   request_civicloc:1,
3992 	   trigger_based:1,
3993 	   non_trigger_based:1,
3994 	   lmr_feedback:1;
3995 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3996 	u8 burst_duration;
3997 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3998 	u8 ftmr_retries;
3999 	u8 bss_color;
4000 };
4001 
4002 /**
4003  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4004  * @addr: MAC address
4005  * @chandef: channel to use
4006  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4007  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4008  */
4009 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4010 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4011 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4012 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4013 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4014 };
4015 
4016 /**
4017  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4018  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4019  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4020  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4021  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4022  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4023  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4024  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4025  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
4026  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4027  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4028  *	zero it means there's no timeout
4029  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4030  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4031  */
4032 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4033 	u64 cookie;
4034 	void *drv_data;
4035 	u32 n_peers;
4036 	u32 nl_portid;
4037 
4038 	u32 timeout;
4039 
4040 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4041 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4042 
4043 	struct list_head list;
4044 
4045 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4046 };
4047 
4048 /**
4049  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4050  *
4051  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4052  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4053  *
4054  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4055  *
4056  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4057  *	has to be done.
4058  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4059  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4060  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4061  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4062  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4063  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4064  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4065  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4066  * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4067  *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4068  *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4069  *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4070  * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4071  *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4072  *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4073  *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4074  */
4075 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4076 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4077 	u16 status;
4078 	const u8 *ie;
4079 	size_t ie_len;
4080 	int assoc_link_id;
4081 	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4082 };
4083 
4084 /**
4085  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4086  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4087  *	for the entire device
4088  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4089  *	for the given interface
4090  * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4091  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4092  *	for these subtypes
4093  */
4094 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4095 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4096 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4097 };
4098 
4099 /**
4100  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4101  *
4102  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4103  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4104  *
4105  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4106  * on success or a negative error code.
4107  *
4108  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4109  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4110  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4111  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4112  *
4113  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4114  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4115  *	configured for the device.
4116  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4117  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4118  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4119  *	the device.
4120  *
4121  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4122  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4123  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4124  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4125  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4126  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4127  *
4128  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4129  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4130  *
4131  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4132  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4133  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4134  *
4135  * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4136  *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4137  *	address is available.
4138  * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4139  *
4140  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4141  *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4142  *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4143  *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4144  *
4145  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4146  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4147  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4148  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4149  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4150  *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4151  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4152  *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4153  *
4154  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4155  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4156  *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4157  *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4158  *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4159  *
4160  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4161  *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4162  *
4163  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4164  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4165  *
4166  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4167  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4168  *
4169  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4170  *
4171  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4172  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4173  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4174  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4175  *
4176  * @add_station: Add a new station.
4177  * @del_station: Remove a station
4178  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4179  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4180  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4181  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4182  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4183  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4184  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4185  *
4186  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4187  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4188  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4189  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4190  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4191  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4192  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4193  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4194  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4195  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4196  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4197  *
4198  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4199  *
4200  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4201  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4202  *	set, and which to leave alone.
4203  *
4204  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4205  *
4206  * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4207  *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4208  *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4209  *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4210  *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4211  *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4212  *
4213  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4214  *
4215  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4216  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4217  *	join the mesh instead.
4218  *
4219  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4220  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4221  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4222  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4223  *
4224  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4225  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4226  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4227  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4228  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4229  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4230  *
4231  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4232  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4233  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4234  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4235  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4236  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4237  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4238  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4239  *
4240  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4241  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4242  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4243  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4244  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4245  *	was received.
4246  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4247  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4248  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4249  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4250  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4251  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4252  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4253  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4254  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4255  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4256  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4257  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4258  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4259  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4260  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4261  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4262  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4263  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4264  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4265  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4266  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4267  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4268  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4269  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4270  *
4271  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4272  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4273  *	to a merge.
4274  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4275  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4276  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4277  *
4278  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4279  *	MESH mode)
4280  *
4281  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4282  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4283  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4284  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4285  *
4286  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4287  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4288  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4289  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4290  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4291  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4292  *	return 0 if successful
4293  *
4294  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4295  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4296  *
4297  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4298  *
4299  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4300  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4301  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4302  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4303  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4304  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4305  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4306  *	the duration value.
4307  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4308  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4309  *	frame on another channel
4310  *
4311  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4312  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4313  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4314  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4315  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4316  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4317  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4318  *
4319  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4320  *
4321  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4322  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4323  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4324  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4325  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4326  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4327  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4328  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4329  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4330  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4331  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4332  *	disabled.)
4333  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4334  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4335  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4336  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4337  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4338  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4339  *	thresholds.
4340  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4341  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4342  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4343  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4344  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4345  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4346  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4347  *
4348  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4349  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4350  *
4351  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4352  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4353  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4354  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4355  *
4356  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4357  *
4358  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4359  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4360  *
4361  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4362  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4363  *
4364  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4365  *
4366  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4367  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4368  *	current monitoring channel.
4369  *
4370  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4371  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4372  *
4373  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4374  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4375  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4376  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4377  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4378  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4379  *
4380  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4381  *
4382  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4383  *	was finished on another phy.
4384  *
4385  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4386  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4387  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4388  *
4389  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4390  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4391  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4392  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4393  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4394  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4395  *
4396  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4397  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4398  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4399  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4400  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4401  *	as soon as possible.
4402  *
4403  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4404  *
4405  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4406  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4407  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4408  *
4409  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4410  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4411  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4412  *	account.
4413  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4414  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4415  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4416  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4417  *	rejected)
4418  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4419  *
4420  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4421  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4422  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4423  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4424  *
4425  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4426  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4427  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4428  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4429  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4430  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4431  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4432  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4433  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4434  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4435  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4436  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4437  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4438  *	provided @nan_func.
4439  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4440  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4441  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4442  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4443  *
4444  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4445  *
4446  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4447  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4448  *
4449  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4450  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4451  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4452  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4453  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4454  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4455  *
4456  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4457  *     user space
4458  *
4459  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4460  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4461  *
4462  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4463  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4464  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4465  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4466  *
4467  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4468  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4469  *	DH IE through this interface.
4470  *
4471  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4472  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4473  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4474  *	This callback may sleep.
4475  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4476  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4477  *
4478  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4479  *
4480  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4481  *
4482  * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4483  *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4484  *	Response frame.
4485  *
4486  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4487  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4488  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4489  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4490  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4491  *	radar channel.
4492  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4493  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4494  * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4495  * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4496  * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4497  *
4498  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4499  */
4500 struct cfg80211_ops {
4501 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4502 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4503 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4504 
4505 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4506 						  const char *name,
4507 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4508 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4509 						  struct vif_params *params);
4510 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4511 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4512 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4513 				       struct net_device *dev,
4514 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4515 				       struct vif_params *params);
4516 
4517 	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4518 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4519 				 unsigned int link_id);
4520 	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4521 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4522 				 unsigned int link_id);
4523 
4524 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4525 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4526 			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4527 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4528 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4529 			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4530 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4531 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4532 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4533 			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4534 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4535 				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4536 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4537 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4538 					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4539 					u8 key_index);
4540 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4541 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4542 					  int link_id,
4543 					  u8 key_index);
4544 
4545 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4546 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4547 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4548 				 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4549 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4550 			   unsigned int link_id);
4551 
4552 
4553 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4554 			       const u8 *mac,
4555 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4556 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4557 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4558 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4559 				  const u8 *mac,
4560 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4561 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4562 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4563 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4564 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4565 
4566 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4567 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4568 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4569 			       const u8 *dst);
4570 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4571 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4572 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4573 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4574 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4575 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4576 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4577 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4578 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4579 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4580 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4581 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4582 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4583 				struct net_device *dev,
4584 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4585 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4586 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4587 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4588 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4589 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4590 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4591 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4592 
4593 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4594 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4595 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4596 
4597 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4598 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4599 
4600 	void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4601 			      const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4602 
4603 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4604 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4605 
4606 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4607 					     struct net_device *dev,
4608 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4609 
4610 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4611 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4612 
4613 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4614 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4615 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4616 
4617 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4618 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4619 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4620 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4621 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4622 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4623 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4624 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4625 
4626 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4627 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4628 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4629 					 struct net_device *dev,
4630 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4631 					 u32 changed);
4632 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4633 			      u16 reason_code);
4634 
4635 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4636 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4637 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4638 
4639 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4640 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4641 
4642 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4643 
4644 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4645 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4646 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4647 				int *dbm);
4648 
4649 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4650 
4651 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4652 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4653 				void *data, int len);
4654 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4655 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4656 				 void *data, int len);
4657 #endif
4658 
4659 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4660 				    struct net_device *dev,
4661 				    unsigned int link_id,
4662 				    const u8 *peer,
4663 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4664 
4665 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4666 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4667 
4668 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4669 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4670 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4671 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4672 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4673 
4674 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4675 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4676 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4677 				     unsigned int duration,
4678 				     u64 *cookie);
4679 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4680 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4681 					    u64 cookie);
4682 
4683 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4684 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4685 			   u64 *cookie);
4686 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4687 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4688 				       u64 cookie);
4689 
4690 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4691 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4692 
4693 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4694 				       struct net_device *dev,
4695 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4696 
4697 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4698 					     struct net_device *dev,
4699 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4700 
4701 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4702 				      struct net_device *dev,
4703 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4704 
4705 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4706 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4707 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4708 
4709 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4710 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4711 
4712 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4713 				struct net_device *dev,
4714 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4715 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4716 				   u64 reqid);
4717 
4718 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4719 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4720 
4721 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4722 			     const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4723 			     u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4724 			     u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4725 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4726 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4727 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4728 
4729 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4730 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4731 
4732 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4733 				  struct net_device *dev,
4734 				  u16 noack_map);
4735 
4736 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4737 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4738 			       unsigned int link_id,
4739 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4740 
4741 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4742 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4743 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4744 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4745 
4746 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4747 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4748 
4749 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4750 					 struct net_device *dev,
4751 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4752 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4753 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4754 				struct net_device *dev);
4755 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4756 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4757 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4758 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4759 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4760 				    u16 duration);
4761 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4762 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4763 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4764 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4765 
4766 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4767 				  struct net_device *dev,
4768 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4769 
4770 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4771 			       struct net_device *dev,
4772 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4773 
4774 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4775 				    unsigned int link_id,
4776 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4777 
4778 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4779 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4780 			     u16 admitted_time);
4781 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4782 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4783 
4784 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4785 				       struct net_device *dev,
4786 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4787 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4788 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4789 					      struct net_device *dev,
4790 					      const u8 *addr);
4791 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4792 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4793 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4794 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4795 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4796 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4797 			       u64 cookie);
4798 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4799 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4800 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4801 				   u32 changes);
4802 
4803 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4804 					    struct net_device *dev,
4805 					    const bool enabled);
4806 
4807 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4808 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4809 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4810 
4811 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4812 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4813 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4814 			   const u8 *aa);
4815 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4816 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4817 
4818 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4819 				   struct net_device *dev,
4820 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4821 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4822 				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4823 				   u64 *cookie);
4824 
4825 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4826 				struct net_device *dev,
4827 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4828 
4829 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4830 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4831 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4832 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4833 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4834 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4835 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4836 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4837 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4838 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4839 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4840 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4841 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4842 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4843 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4844 				struct net_device *dev,
4845 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4846 	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4847 				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4848 	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4849 					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4850 	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4851 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4852 	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4853 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4854 	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4855 				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4856 	int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4857 				    struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4858 };
4859 
4860 /*
4861  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4862  * and registration/helper functions
4863  */
4864 
4865 /**
4866  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4867  *
4868  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4869  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4870  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4871  *	wiphy at all
4872  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4873  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4874  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4875  *	reason to override the default
4876  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4877  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4878  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4879  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4880  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4881  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4882  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4883  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4884  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4885  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4886  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4887  *	firmware.
4888  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4889  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4890  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4891  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4892  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4893  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4894  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4895  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4896  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4897  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4898  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4899  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4900  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4901  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4902  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4903  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4904  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4905  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4906  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4907  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4908  *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
4909  *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
4910  *	should set this flag for now.
4911  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
4912  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
4913  *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
4914  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
4915  *	set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
4916  */
4917 enum wiphy_flags {
4918 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4919 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
4920 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4921 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4922 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4923 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4924 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4925 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4926 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4927 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4928 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
4929 	/* use hole at 12 */
4930 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4931 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4932 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4933 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4934 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4935 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4936 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4937 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4938 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4939 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4940 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4941 	WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24),
4942 	WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON     = BIT(25),
4943 };
4944 
4945 /**
4946  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4947  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4948  * @types: interface types (bits)
4949  */
4950 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4951 	u16 max;
4952 	u16 types;
4953 };
4954 
4955 /**
4956  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4957  *
4958  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4959  * combinations it supports concurrently.
4960  *
4961  * Examples:
4962  *
4963  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4964  *
4965  *    .. code-block:: c
4966  *
4967  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4968  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4969  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
4970  *	};
4971  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4972  *		.limits = limits1,
4973  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4974  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4975  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4976  *	};
4977  *
4978  *
4979  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4980  *
4981  *    .. code-block:: c
4982  *
4983  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4984  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4985  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4986  *	};
4987  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4988  *		.limits = limits2,
4989  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4990  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4991  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4992  *	};
4993  *
4994  *
4995  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4996  *
4997  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4998  *
4999  *    .. code-block:: c
5000  *
5001  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5002  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5003  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5004  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5005  *	};
5006  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5007  *		.limits = limits3,
5008  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5009  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
5010  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
5011  *	};
5012  *
5013  */
5014 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5015 	/**
5016 	 * @limits:
5017 	 * limits for the given interface types
5018 	 */
5019 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5020 
5021 	/**
5022 	 * @num_different_channels:
5023 	 * can use up to this many different channels
5024 	 */
5025 	u32 num_different_channels;
5026 
5027 	/**
5028 	 * @max_interfaces:
5029 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5030 	 */
5031 	u16 max_interfaces;
5032 
5033 	/**
5034 	 * @n_limits:
5035 	 * number of limitations
5036 	 */
5037 	u8 n_limits;
5038 
5039 	/**
5040 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5041 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5042 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5043 	 */
5044 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5045 
5046 	/**
5047 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
5048 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5049 	 */
5050 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
5051 
5052 	/**
5053 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
5054 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5055 	 */
5056 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
5057 
5058 	/**
5059 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5060 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5061 	 *
5062 	 * = 0
5063 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5064 	 * > 0
5065 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5066 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5067 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5068 	 */
5069 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5070 };
5071 
5072 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5073 	u16 tx, rx;
5074 };
5075 
5076 /**
5077  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5078  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5079  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5080  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5081  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5082  *	packet should be preserved in that case
5083  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5084  *	(see nl80211.h)
5085  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5086  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5087  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5088  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5089  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5090  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5091  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5092  */
5093 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5094 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
5095 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
5096 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
5097 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
5098 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
5099 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
5100 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
5101 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
5102 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
5103 };
5104 
5105 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5106 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5107 	u32 data_payload_max;
5108 	u32 data_interval_max;
5109 	u32 wake_payload_max;
5110 	bool seq;
5111 };
5112 
5113 /**
5114  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5115  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5116  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5117  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5118  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5119  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5120  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5121  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5122  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5123  *	scheduled scans.
5124  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5125  *	details.
5126  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5127  */
5128 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5129 	u32 flags;
5130 	int n_patterns;
5131 	int pattern_max_len;
5132 	int pattern_min_len;
5133 	int max_pkt_offset;
5134 	int max_nd_match_sets;
5135 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5136 };
5137 
5138 /**
5139  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5140  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5141  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5142  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5143  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5144  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5145  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5146  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5147  */
5148 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5149 	int n_rules;
5150 	int max_delay;
5151 	int n_patterns;
5152 	int pattern_max_len;
5153 	int pattern_min_len;
5154 	int max_pkt_offset;
5155 };
5156 
5157 /**
5158  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5159  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5160  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5161  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5162  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5163  */
5164 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5165 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5166 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5167 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5168 };
5169 
5170 /**
5171  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5172  *
5173  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5174  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5175  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5176  *
5177  */
5178 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5179 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5180 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5181 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5182 };
5183 
5184 /**
5185  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5186  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5187  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5188  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5189  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5190  */
5191 
5192 struct sta_opmode_info {
5193 	u32 changed;
5194 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5195 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5196 	u8 rx_nss;
5197 };
5198 
5199 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5200 
5201 /**
5202  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5203  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5204  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5205  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5206  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5207  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5208  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5209  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5210  *	dumpit calls.
5211  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5212  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5213  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5214  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5215  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5216  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5217  * are used with dump requests.
5218  */
5219 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5220 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5221 	u32 flags;
5222 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5223 		    const void *data, int data_len);
5224 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5225 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5226 		      unsigned long *storage);
5227 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5228 	unsigned int maxattr;
5229 };
5230 
5231 /**
5232  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5233  * @iftype: interface type
5234  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5235  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5236  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5237  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5238  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5239  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5240  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5241  * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5242  * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5243  */
5244 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5245 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5246 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5247 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5248 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5249 	u16 eml_capabilities;
5250 	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5251 };
5252 
5253 /**
5254  * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5255  * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5256  * @type: the interface type to look up
5257  */
5258 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5259 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5260 
5261 /**
5262  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5263  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5264  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5265  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5266  * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5267  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5268  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5269  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5270  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5271  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5272  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5273  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5274  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5275  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5276  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5277  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5278  *	not limited)
5279  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5280  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5281  */
5282 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5283 	unsigned int max_peers;
5284 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5285 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5286 
5287 	struct {
5288 		u32 preambles;
5289 		u32 bandwidths;
5290 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5291 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5292 		u8 supported:1,
5293 		   asap:1,
5294 		   non_asap:1,
5295 		   request_lci:1,
5296 		   request_civicloc:1,
5297 		   trigger_based:1,
5298 		   non_trigger_based:1;
5299 	} ftm;
5300 };
5301 
5302 /**
5303  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5304  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5305  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5306  *
5307  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5308  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5309  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5310  */
5311 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5312 	u16 iftypes_mask;
5313 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5314 	int n_akm_suites;
5315 };
5316 
5317 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff
5318 
5319 /**
5320  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5321  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5322  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5323  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5324  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5325  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5326  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5327  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5328  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5329  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5330  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5331  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5332  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5333  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5334  *	iftype_akm_suites.
5335  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5336  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5337  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5338  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5339  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5340  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5341  *	suites are specified separately.
5342  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5343  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5344  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5345  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5346  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5347  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5348  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5349  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5350  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5351  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5352  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5353  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5354  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5355  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5356  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5357  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5358  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5359  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5360  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5361  *	unregister hardware
5362  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5363  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5364  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5365  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5366  *	(see below).
5367  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5368  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5369  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5370  *	must be set by driver
5371  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5372  *	list single interface types.
5373  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5374  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5375  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5376  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5377  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5378  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5379  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5380  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5381  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5382  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5383  *	this variable determines its size
5384  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5385  *	any given scan
5386  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5387  *	the device can run concurrently.
5388  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5389  *	for in any given scheduled scan
5390  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5391  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5392  *	supported.
5393  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5394  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5395  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5396  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5397  *	scans
5398  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5399  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5400  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5401  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5402  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5403  *	scan plan supported by the device.
5404  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5405  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5406  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5407  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5408  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5409  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5410  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5411  *
5412  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5413  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5414  *	type
5415  *
5416  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5417  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5418  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5419  *
5420  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5421  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5422  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5423  *
5424  * @probe_resp_offload:
5425  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5426  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5427  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5428  *
5429  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5430  *	may request, if implemented.
5431  *
5432  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5433  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5434  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5435  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5436  *
5437  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5438  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5439  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5440  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5441  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5442  *
5443  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5444  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5445  *
5446  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5447  *	supports for ACL.
5448  *
5449  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5450  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5451  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5452  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5453  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5454  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5455  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5456  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5457  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5458  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5459  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5460  *	capabilities are specified separately.
5461  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5462  *
5463  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5464  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5465  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5466  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5467  *
5468  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5469  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5470  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5471  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5472  *
5473  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5474  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5475  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5476  *	infinite.
5477  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5478  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5479  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5480  *
5481  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5482  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5483  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5484  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5485  *
5486  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5487  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5488  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5489  *
5490  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5491  *	wake_tx_queue
5492  *
5493  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5494  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5495  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5496  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5497  *
5498  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5499  *
5500  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5501  *	device has
5502  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5503  *	supported by the driver for each vif
5504  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5505  *	supported by the driver for each peer
5506  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5507  *	long/short retry configuration
5508  *
5509  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5510  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5511  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5512  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5513  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5514  *
5515  * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5516  *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5517  *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5518  * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5519  *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5520  *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5521  * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5522  *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5523  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5524  *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5525  *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5526  *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5527  *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5528  *
5529  * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5530  *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5531  *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5532  *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5533  *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5534  *	specify a mac address).
5535  */
5536 struct wiphy {
5537 	struct mutex mtx;
5538 
5539 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5540 
5541 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5542 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5543 
5544 	struct mac_address *addresses;
5545 
5546 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5547 
5548 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5549 	int n_iface_combinations;
5550 	u16 software_iftypes;
5551 
5552 	u16 n_addresses;
5553 
5554 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5555 	u16 interface_modes;
5556 
5557 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5558 
5559 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5560 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5561 
5562 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5563 
5564 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5565 
5566 	int bss_priv_size;
5567 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5568 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5569 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5570 	u8 max_match_sets;
5571 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5572 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5573 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5574 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5575 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5576 
5577 	int n_cipher_suites;
5578 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5579 
5580 	int n_akm_suites;
5581 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5582 
5583 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5584 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5585 
5586 	u8 retry_short;
5587 	u8 retry_long;
5588 	u32 frag_threshold;
5589 	u32 rts_threshold;
5590 	u8 coverage_class;
5591 
5592 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5593 	u32 hw_version;
5594 
5595 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5596 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5597 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5598 #endif
5599 
5600 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5601 
5602 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5603 
5604 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5605 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5606 
5607 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5608 
5609 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5610 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5611 
5612 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5613 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5614 
5615 	const void *privid;
5616 
5617 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5618 
5619 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5620 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5621 
5622 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5623 
5624 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5625 
5626 	struct device dev;
5627 
5628 	bool registered;
5629 
5630 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5631 
5632 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5633 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5634 
5635 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5636 
5637 	possible_net_t _net;
5638 
5639 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5640 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5641 #endif
5642 
5643 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5644 
5645 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5646 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5647 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5648 
5649 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5650 
5651 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5652 
5653 	u32 bss_select_support;
5654 
5655 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5656 
5657 	u32 txq_limit;
5658 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5659 	u32 txq_quantum;
5660 
5661 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5662 
5663 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5664 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5665 
5666 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5667 
5668 	struct {
5669 		u64 peer, vif;
5670 		u8 max_retry;
5671 	} tid_config_support;
5672 
5673 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5674 
5675 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5676 
5677 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5678 
5679 	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5680 	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5681 	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5682 
5683 	u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5684 
5685 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5686 };
5687 
5688 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5689 {
5690 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5691 }
5692 
5693 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5694 {
5695 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5696 }
5697 
5698 /**
5699  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5700  *
5701  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5702  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5703  */
5704 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5705 {
5706 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5707 	return &wiphy->priv;
5708 }
5709 
5710 /**
5711  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5712  *
5713  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5714  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5715  */
5716 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5717 {
5718 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5719 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5720 }
5721 
5722 /**
5723  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5724  *
5725  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5726  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5727  */
5728 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5729 {
5730 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5731 }
5732 
5733 /**
5734  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5735  *
5736  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5737  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5738  */
5739 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5740 {
5741 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5742 }
5743 
5744 /**
5745  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5746  *
5747  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5748  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5749  */
5750 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5751 {
5752 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5753 }
5754 
5755 /**
5756  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5757  *
5758  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5759  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5760  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5761  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5762  *
5763  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5764  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5765  *
5766  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5767  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5768  */
5769 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5770 			   const char *requested_name);
5771 
5772 /**
5773  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5774  *
5775  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5776  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5777  *
5778  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5779  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5780  *
5781  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5782  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5783  */
5784 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5785 				      int sizeof_priv)
5786 {
5787 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5788 }
5789 
5790 /**
5791  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5792  *
5793  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5794  *
5795  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5796  */
5797 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5798 
5799 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5800 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5801 
5802 /**
5803  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5804  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5805  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5806  *
5807  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5808  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5809  */
5810 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5811         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5812 
5813 /**
5814  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5815  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5816  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5817  *
5818  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5819  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5820  */
5821 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5822         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5823 
5824 /**
5825  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5826  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5827  */
5828 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5829 
5830 /**
5831  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5832  *
5833  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5834  *
5835  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5836  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5837  * request that is being handled.
5838  */
5839 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5840 
5841 /**
5842  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5843  *
5844  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5845  */
5846 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5847 
5848 /* internal structs */
5849 struct cfg80211_conn;
5850 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5851 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5852 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5853 
5854 /**
5855  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5856  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5857  *
5858  * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
5859  * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
5860  * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
5861  * differentiate which way it's called.
5862  *
5863  * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
5864  *
5865  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5866  *
5867  * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
5868  * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
5869  */
5870 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5871 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5872 {
5873 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5874 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5875 }
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5879  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5880  */
5881 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5882 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5883 {
5884 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5885 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5886 }
5887 
5888 struct wiphy_work;
5889 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
5890 
5891 struct wiphy_work {
5892 	struct list_head entry;
5893 	wiphy_work_func_t func;
5894 };
5895 
5896 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
5897 				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5898 {
5899 	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
5900 	work->func = func;
5901 }
5902 
5903 /**
5904  * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
5905  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5906  * @work: the work item
5907  *
5908  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5909  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5910  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5911  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5912  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5913  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5914  */
5915 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5916 
5917 /**
5918  * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
5919  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5920  * @work: the work to cancel
5921  *
5922  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5923  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5924  */
5925 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5926 
5927 /**
5928  * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
5929  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5930  * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
5931  *
5932  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5933  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5934  */
5935 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5936 
5937 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
5938 	struct wiphy_work work;
5939 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5940 	struct timer_list timer;
5941 };
5942 
5943 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
5944 
5945 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
5946 					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5947 {
5948 	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
5949 	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
5950 }
5951 
5952 /**
5953  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
5954  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5955  * @dwork: the delayable worker
5956  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5957  *
5958  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5959  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5960  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5961  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5962  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5963  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5964  */
5965 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5966 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
5967 			      unsigned long delay);
5968 
5969 /**
5970  * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
5971  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5972  * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
5973  *
5974  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5975  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5976  */
5977 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5978 			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
5979 
5980 /**
5981  * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
5982  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5983  * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
5984  *
5985  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5986  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5987  */
5988 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5989 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
5990 
5991 /**
5992  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5993  *
5994  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5995  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5996  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5997  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5998  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
5999  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6000  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6001  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6002  *
6003  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6004  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6005  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6006  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6007  *
6008  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6009  * @iftype: interface type
6010  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6011  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6012  *	for the notifier
6013  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6014  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6015  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6016  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
6017  * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6018  * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6019  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
6020  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6021  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6022  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6023  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6024  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6025  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6026  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6027  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6028  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6029  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6030  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6031  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6032  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6033  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6034  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6035  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
6036  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6037  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6038  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
6039  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
6040  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
6041  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6042  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6043  *	the P2P Device.
6044  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
6045  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
6046  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6047  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6048  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6049  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6050  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6051  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6052  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6053  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6054  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6055  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6056  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6057  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6058  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6059  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6060  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6061  * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6062  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6063  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6064  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6065  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6066  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6067  *	unprotected beacon report
6068  * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6069  *	@ap and @client for each link
6070  * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6071  */
6072 struct wireless_dev {
6073 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6074 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6075 
6076 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6077 	struct list_head list;
6078 	struct net_device *netdev;
6079 
6080 	u32 identifier;
6081 
6082 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6083 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6084 
6085 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6086 
6087 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6088 
6089 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6090 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6091 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6092 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6093 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6094 
6095 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6096 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6097 
6098 	struct list_head event_list;
6099 	spinlock_t event_lock;
6100 
6101 	u8 connected:1;
6102 
6103 	bool ps;
6104 	int ps_timeout;
6105 
6106 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6107 
6108 	u32 owner_nlportid;
6109 	bool nl_owner_dead;
6110 
6111 	/* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */
6112 	bool cac_started;
6113 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
6114 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6115 
6116 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6117 	/* wext data */
6118 	struct {
6119 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6120 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6121 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6122 		const u8 *ie;
6123 		size_t ie_len;
6124 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6125 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6126 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6127 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6128 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
6129 	} wext;
6130 #endif
6131 
6132 	struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6133 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6134 
6135 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6136 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6137 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6138 
6139 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6140 
6141 	union {
6142 		struct {
6143 			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6144 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6145 			u8 ssid_len;
6146 		} client;
6147 		struct {
6148 			int beacon_interval;
6149 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6150 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6151 			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6152 			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6153 		} mesh;
6154 		struct {
6155 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6156 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6157 			u8 ssid_len;
6158 		} ap;
6159 		struct {
6160 			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6161 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6162 			int beacon_interval;
6163 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6164 			u8 ssid_len;
6165 		} ibss;
6166 		struct {
6167 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6168 		} ocb;
6169 	} u;
6170 
6171 	struct {
6172 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6173 		union {
6174 			struct {
6175 				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6176 				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6177 			} ap;
6178 			struct {
6179 				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6180 			} client;
6181 		};
6182 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6183 	u16 valid_links;
6184 };
6185 
6186 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6187 {
6188 	if (wdev->netdev)
6189 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6190 	return wdev->address;
6191 }
6192 
6193 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6194 {
6195 	if (wdev->netdev)
6196 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6197 	return wdev->is_running;
6198 }
6199 
6200 /**
6201  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6202  *
6203  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6204  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6205  */
6206 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6207 {
6208 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6209 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6210 }
6211 
6212 /**
6213  * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6214  * @wdev: the wdev
6215  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6216  *
6217  * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6218  */
6219 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6220 				       unsigned int link_id);
6221 
6222 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6223 					unsigned int link_id)
6224 {
6225 	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6226 	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6227 		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6228 }
6229 
6230 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6231 	for (link_id = 0;					\
6232 	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6233 			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6234 	     link_id++)						\
6235 		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6236 		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6237 
6238 /**
6239  * DOC: Utility functions
6240  *
6241  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6242  */
6243 
6244 /**
6245  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6246  *
6247  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6248  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6249  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6250  */
6251 static inline bool
6252 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6253 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6254 {
6255 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6256 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6257 }
6258 
6259 /**
6260  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6261  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6262  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6263  */
6264 static inline u32
6265 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6266 {
6267 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6268 }
6269 
6270 /**
6271  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6272  *
6273  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6274  * @chan: channel
6275  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6276  */
6277 enum nl80211_chan_width
6278 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6279 
6280 /**
6281  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6282  * @chan: channel number
6283  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6284  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6285  */
6286 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6287 
6288 /**
6289  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6290  * @chan: channel number
6291  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6292  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6293  */
6294 static inline int
6295 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6296 {
6297 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6298 }
6299 
6300 /**
6301  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6302  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6303  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6304  */
6305 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6306 
6307 /**
6308  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6309  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6310  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6311  */
6312 static inline int
6313 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6314 {
6315 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6316 }
6317 
6318 /**
6319  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6320  * frequency
6321  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6322  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6323  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6324  */
6325 struct ieee80211_channel *
6326 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6327 
6328 /**
6329  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6330  *
6331  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6332  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6333  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6334  */
6335 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
6336 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6337 {
6338 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6339 }
6340 
6341 /**
6342  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6343  * @chan: control channel to check
6344  *
6345  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6346  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6347  */
6348 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6349 {
6350 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6351 		return false;
6352 
6353 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6354 }
6355 
6356 /**
6357  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6358  *
6359  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6360  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6361  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6362  *
6363  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6364  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6365  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6366  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6367  */
6368 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6369 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6370 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6371 
6372 /**
6373  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6374  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6375  *
6376  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
6377  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6378  */
6379 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6380 
6381 /*
6382  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6383  *
6384  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6385  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6386  */
6387 
6388 struct radiotap_align_size {
6389 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6390 };
6391 
6392 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6393 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6394 	int n_bits;
6395 	uint32_t oui;
6396 	uint8_t subns;
6397 };
6398 
6399 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6400 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6401 	int n_ns;
6402 };
6403 
6404 /**
6405  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6406  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6407  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6408  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6409  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6410  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6411  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6412  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6413  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6414  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6415  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6416  *	radiotap namespace or not
6417  *
6418  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6419  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6420  * @_arg_index: next argument index
6421  * @_arg: next argument pointer
6422  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6423  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6424  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6425  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6426  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6427  *	next bitmap word
6428  *
6429  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6430  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6431  */
6432 
6433 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6434 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6435 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6436 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6437 
6438 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6439 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6440 
6441 	unsigned char *this_arg;
6442 	int this_arg_index;
6443 	int this_arg_size;
6444 
6445 	int is_radiotap_ns;
6446 
6447 	int _max_length;
6448 	int _arg_index;
6449 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6450 	int _reset_on_ext;
6451 };
6452 
6453 int
6454 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6455 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6456 				 int max_length,
6457 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6458 
6459 int
6460 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6461 
6462 
6463 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6464 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6465 
6466 /**
6467  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6468  *
6469  * @skb: the frame
6470  *
6471  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6472  * returns the 802.11 header length.
6473  *
6474  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6475  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6476  * 802.11 header.
6477  */
6478 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6479 
6480 /**
6481  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6482  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6483  * Return: The header length in bytes.
6484  */
6485 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6486 
6487 /**
6488  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6489  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6490  *	(first byte) will be accessed
6491  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6492  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6493  */
6494 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6495 
6496 /**
6497  * DOC: Data path helpers
6498  *
6499  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6500  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6501  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6502  */
6503 
6504 /**
6505  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6506  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6507  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6508  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6509  * @addr: the device MAC address
6510  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6511  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6512  * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6513  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6514  */
6515 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6516 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6517 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6518 
6519 /**
6520  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6521  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6522  * @addr: the device MAC address
6523  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6524  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6525  */
6526 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6527 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6528 {
6529 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6530 }
6531 
6532 /**
6533  * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6534  *
6535  * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6536  * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6537  * mesh control field.
6538  *
6539  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6540  * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6541  *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6542  *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6543  *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6544  * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6545  */
6546 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6547 
6548 /**
6549  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6550  *
6551  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6552  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6553  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6554  *
6555  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6556  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6557  *	initialized by the caller.
6558  * @addr: The device MAC address.
6559  * @iftype: The device interface type.
6560  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6561  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6562  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6563  * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6564  */
6565 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6566 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6567 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6568 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6569 			      u8 mesh_control);
6570 
6571 /**
6572  * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6573  *
6574  * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6575  * protocol.
6576  *
6577  * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6578  * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6579  * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6580  */
6581 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6582 
6583 /**
6584  * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6585  *
6586  * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6587  * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6588  * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6589  *
6590  * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6591  */
6592 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6593 
6594 /**
6595  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6596  * @skb: the data frame
6597  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6598  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6599  */
6600 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6601 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6602 
6603 /**
6604  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6605  *
6606  * @eid: element ID
6607  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6608  * @len: length of data
6609  * @match: byte array to match
6610  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6611  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6612  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6613  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6614  *	the data portion instead.
6615  *
6616  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6617  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6618  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6619  * requested element struct.
6620  *
6621  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6622  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6623  * byte array to match.
6624  */
6625 const struct element *
6626 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6627 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6628 			 unsigned int match_offset);
6629 
6630 /**
6631  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6632  *
6633  * @eid: element ID
6634  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6635  * @len: length of data
6636  * @match: byte array to match
6637  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6638  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6639  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6640  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6641  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6642  *	the second byte is the IE length.
6643  *
6644  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6645  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6646  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6647  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6648  * element ID.
6649  *
6650  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6651  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6652  * byte array to match.
6653  */
6654 static inline const u8 *
6655 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6656 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6657 		       unsigned int match_offset)
6658 {
6659 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6660 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6661 	 */
6662 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6663 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6664 		return NULL;
6665 
6666 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6667 						      match, match_len,
6668 						      match_offset ?
6669 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6670 }
6671 
6672 /**
6673  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6674  *
6675  * @eid: element ID
6676  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6677  * @len: length of data
6678  *
6679  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6680  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6681  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6682  * requested element struct.
6683  *
6684  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6685  * having to fit into the given data.
6686  */
6687 static inline const struct element *
6688 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6689 {
6690 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6691 }
6692 
6693 /**
6694  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6695  *
6696  * @eid: element ID
6697  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6698  * @len: length of data
6699  *
6700  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6701  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6702  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6703  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6704  *
6705  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6706  * having to fit into the given data.
6707  */
6708 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6709 {
6710 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6711 }
6712 
6713 /**
6714  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6715  *
6716  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6717  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6718  * @len: length of data
6719  *
6720  * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
6721  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6722  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6723  * requested element struct.
6724  *
6725  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6726  * having to fit into the given data.
6727  */
6728 static inline const struct element *
6729 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6730 {
6731 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6732 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
6733 }
6734 
6735 /**
6736  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6737  *
6738  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6739  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6740  * @len: length of data
6741  *
6742  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6743  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6744  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6745  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6746  *
6747  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6748  * having to fit into the given data.
6749  */
6750 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6751 {
6752 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6753 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6754 }
6755 
6756 /**
6757  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6758  *
6759  * @oui: vendor OUI
6760  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6761  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6762  * @len: length of data
6763  *
6764  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6765  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6766  * return the element structure for the requested element.
6767  *
6768  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6769  * the given data.
6770  */
6771 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6772 						const u8 *ies,
6773 						unsigned int len);
6774 
6775 /**
6776  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6777  *
6778  * @oui: vendor OUI
6779  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6780  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6781  * @len: length of data
6782  *
6783  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6784  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6785  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6786  * element ID.
6787  *
6788  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6789  * the given data.
6790  */
6791 static inline const u8 *
6792 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6793 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6794 {
6795 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6796 }
6797 
6798 /**
6799  * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
6800  *
6801  * @elem: the element to defragment
6802  * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
6803  * @ieslen: length of @ies
6804  * @data: buffer to store element data
6805  * @data_len: length of @data
6806  * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
6807  *
6808  * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
6809  *
6810  * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
6811  * skipping all headers.
6812  *
6813  * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
6814  * element in-place.
6815  */
6816 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
6817 				    size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
6818 				    u8 frag_id);
6819 
6820 /**
6821  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6822  *
6823  * @dev: network device
6824  * @addr: STA MAC address
6825  *
6826  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6827  * devices upon STA association.
6828  */
6829 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6830 
6831 /**
6832  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6833  *
6834  * TODO
6835  */
6836 
6837 /**
6838  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6839  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6840  *	conflicts)
6841  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6842  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6843  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6844  *	alpha2.
6845  *
6846  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6847  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6848  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6849  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6850  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6851  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6852  *
6853  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6854  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6855  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6856  *
6857  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6858  * an -ENOMEM.
6859  *
6860  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6861  */
6862 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6863 
6864 /**
6865  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6866  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6867  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6868  *
6869  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6870  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6871  * information.
6872  *
6873  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6874  */
6875 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6876 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6877 
6878 /**
6879  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6880  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6881  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6882  *
6883  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6884  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6885  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6886  *
6887  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6888  */
6889 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6890 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6891 
6892 /**
6893  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6894  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6895  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6896  *
6897  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6898  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6899  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6900  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6901  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6902  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6903  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6904  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6905  * that called this helper.
6906  */
6907 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6908 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6909 
6910 /**
6911  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6912  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6913  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6914  *
6915  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6916  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6917  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6918  * and processed already.
6919  *
6920  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6921  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6922  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6923  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6924  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6925  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6926  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6927  */
6928 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6929 					       u32 center_freq);
6930 
6931 /**
6932  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6933  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6934  *
6935  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6936  * proper string representation.
6937  */
6938 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6939 
6940 /**
6941  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6942  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6943  *
6944  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
6945  */
6946 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6947 
6948 /**
6949  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
6950  *
6951  */
6952 
6953 /**
6954  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6955  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6956  *
6957  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6958  * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
6959  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6960  *
6961  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
6962  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6963  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6964  *
6965  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6966  * an -ENODATA.
6967  *
6968  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6969  */
6970 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6971 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6972 
6973 /*
6974  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6975  * functions and BSS handling helpers
6976  */
6977 
6978 /**
6979  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6980  *
6981  * @request: the corresponding scan request
6982  * @info: information about the completed scan
6983  */
6984 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6985 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6986 
6987 /**
6988  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6989  *
6990  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6991  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6992  */
6993 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6994 
6995 /**
6996  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6997  *
6998  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6999  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7000  *
7001  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7002  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7003  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7004  */
7005 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7006 
7007 /**
7008  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7009  *
7010  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7011  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7012  *
7013  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7014  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7015  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7016  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7017  */
7018 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7019 
7020 /**
7021  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7022  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7023  * @data: the BSS metadata
7024  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7025  * @len: length of the management frame
7026  * @gfp: context flags
7027  *
7028  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7029  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7030  *
7031  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7032  * Or %NULL on error.
7033  */
7034 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7035 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7036 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7037 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7038 			       gfp_t gfp);
7039 
7040 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7041 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7042 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7043 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7044 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7045 {
7046 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7047 		.chan = rx_channel,
7048 		.signal = signal,
7049 	};
7050 
7051 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7052 }
7053 
7054 /**
7055  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7056  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7057  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7058  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7059  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7060  */
7061 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7062 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7063 {
7064 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7065 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7066 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
7067 
7068 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7069 
7070 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7071 
7072 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7073 }
7074 
7075 /**
7076  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7077  * @element: element to check
7078  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7079  */
7080 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7081 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7082 
7083 /**
7084  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7085  * @ie: ies
7086  * @ielen: length of IEs
7087  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7088  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7089  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7090  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7091  */
7092 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7093 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7094 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
7095 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7096 
7097 /**
7098  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7099  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7100  *	from a beacon or probe response
7101  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7102  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7103  */
7104 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7105 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7106 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7107 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7108 };
7109 
7110 /**
7111  * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7112  * @ie: IEs
7113  * @ielen: length of IEs
7114  * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7115  *
7116  * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7117  */
7118 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7119 				    enum nl80211_band band);
7120 
7121 /**
7122  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7123  *
7124  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7125  * @data: the BSS metadata
7126  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7127  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7128  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7129  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7130  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7131  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7132  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7133  * @gfp: context flags
7134  *
7135  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7136  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7137  *
7138  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7139  * Or %NULL on error.
7140  */
7141 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7142 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7143 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7144 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7145 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7146 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7147 			 gfp_t gfp);
7148 
7149 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7150 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7151 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7152 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7153 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7154 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7155 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7156 {
7157 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7158 		.chan = rx_channel,
7159 		.signal = signal,
7160 	};
7161 
7162 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7163 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7164 					gfp);
7165 }
7166 
7167 /**
7168  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7169  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7170  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7171  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7172  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7173  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7174  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7175  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7176  */
7177 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7178 				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7179 				      const u8 *bssid,
7180 				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7181 				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7182 				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
7183 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
7184 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7185 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7186 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7187 {
7188 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7189 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7190 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7191 }
7192 
7193 /**
7194  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7195  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7196  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7197  *
7198  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7199  */
7200 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7201 
7202 /**
7203  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7204  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7205  * @bss: the BSS struct
7206  *
7207  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7208  */
7209 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7210 
7211 /**
7212  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7213  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7214  * @bss: the bss to remove
7215  *
7216  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7217  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7218  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7219  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7220  */
7221 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7222 
7223 /**
7224  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7225  *
7226  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7227  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7228  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7229  *
7230  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7231  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7232  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7233  * @iter: the iterator function to call
7234  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7235  */
7236 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7237 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7238 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7239 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7240 				    void *data),
7241 		       void *iter_data);
7242 
7243 /**
7244  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7245  * @dev: network device
7246  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7247  * @len: length of the frame data
7248  *
7249  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7250  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7251  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7252  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7253  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7254  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7255  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7256  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7257  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7258  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7259  *
7260  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7261  */
7262 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7263 
7264 /**
7265  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7266  * @dev: network device
7267  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7268  *
7269  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7270  * mutex.
7271  */
7272 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7273 
7274 /**
7275  * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7276  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
7277  *	moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7278  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7279  * @len: length of the frame data
7280  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7281  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7282  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7283  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7284  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7285  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7286  *	non-MLO connections
7287  * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7288  *	were rejected by the AP.
7289  */
7290 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7291 	const u8 *buf;
7292 	size_t len;
7293 	const u8 *req_ies;
7294 	size_t req_ies_len;
7295 	int uapsd_queues;
7296 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7297 	struct {
7298 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7299 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7300 		u16 status;
7301 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7302 };
7303 
7304 /**
7305  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7306  * @dev: network device
7307  * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7308  *
7309  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7310  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7311  *
7312  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7313  */
7314 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7315 			    struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7316 
7317 /**
7318  * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7319  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7320  * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7321  *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7322  * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7323  *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7324  *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7325  */
7326 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7327 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7328 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7329 	bool timeout;
7330 };
7331 
7332 /**
7333  * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7334  * @dev: network device
7335  * @data: data describing the association failure
7336  *
7337  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7338  */
7339 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7340 			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7341 
7342 /**
7343  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7344  * @dev: network device
7345  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7346  * @len: length of the frame data
7347  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7348  *
7349  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7350  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7351  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7352  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7353  */
7354 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7355 			   bool reconnect);
7356 
7357 /**
7358  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7359  * @dev: network device
7360  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7361  * @len: length of the frame data
7362  *
7363  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7364  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7365  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7366  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7367  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7368  *
7369  * This function may sleep.
7370  */
7371 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7372 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7373 
7374 /**
7375  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7376  * @dev: network device
7377  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7378  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7379  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7380  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7381  * @gfp: allocation flags
7382  *
7383  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7384  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7385  * primitive.
7386  */
7387 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7388 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7389 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7390 
7391 /**
7392  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7393  *
7394  * @dev: network device
7395  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7396  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7397  * @gfp: allocation flags
7398  *
7399  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7400  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7401  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7402  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7403  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7404  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7405  */
7406 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7407 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7408 
7409 /**
7410  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7411  * 					candidate
7412  *
7413  * @dev: network device
7414  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7415  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7416  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7417  * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7418  * @gfp: allocation flags
7419  *
7420  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7421  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7422  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7423  */
7424 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7425 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7426 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7427 
7428 /**
7429  * DOC: RFkill integration
7430  *
7431  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7432  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7433  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7434  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
7435  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7436  *
7437  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7438  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7439  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7440  */
7441 
7442 /**
7443  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7444  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7445  * @blocked: block status
7446  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7447  */
7448 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7449 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7450 
7451 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7452 {
7453 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7454 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7455 }
7456 
7457 /**
7458  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7459  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7460  */
7461 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7462 
7463 /**
7464  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7465  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7466  */
7467 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7468 {
7469 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7470 }
7471 
7472 /**
7473  * DOC: Vendor commands
7474  *
7475  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7476  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7477  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7478  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7479  * the configuration mechanism.
7480  *
7481  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7482  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
7483  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7484  *
7485  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7486  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7487  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7488  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7489  * managers etc. need.
7490  */
7491 
7492 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7493 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7494 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7495 					   int approxlen);
7496 
7497 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7498 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7499 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7500 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7501 					   unsigned int portid,
7502 					   int vendor_event_idx,
7503 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7504 
7505 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7506 
7507 /**
7508  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7509  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7510  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7511  *	be put into the skb
7512  *
7513  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7514  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7515  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7516  *
7517  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7518  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7519  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7520  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7521  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7522  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7523  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7524  *
7525  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7526  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7527  *
7528  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7529  */
7530 static inline struct sk_buff *
7531 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7532 {
7533 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7534 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7535 }
7536 
7537 /**
7538  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7539  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7540  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7541  *
7542  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7543  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7544  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7545  * skb regardless of the return value.
7546  *
7547  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7548  */
7549 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7550 
7551 /**
7552  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7553  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7554  *
7555  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7556  * Valid to call only there.
7557  */
7558 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7559 
7560 /**
7561  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7562  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7563  * @wdev: the wireless device
7564  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7565  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7566  *	be put into the skb
7567  * @gfp: allocation flags
7568  *
7569  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7570  * vendor-specific multicast group.
7571  *
7572  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7573  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7574  * attribute.
7575  *
7576  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7577  * skb to send the event.
7578  *
7579  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7580  */
7581 static inline struct sk_buff *
7582 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7583 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7584 {
7585 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7586 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7587 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7588 }
7589 
7590 /**
7591  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7592  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7593  * @wdev: the wireless device
7594  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7595  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7596  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7597  *	be put into the skb
7598  * @gfp: allocation flags
7599  *
7600  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7601  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7602  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7603  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7604  *
7605  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7606  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7607  * attribute.
7608  *
7609  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7610  * skb to send the event.
7611  *
7612  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7613  */
7614 static inline struct sk_buff *
7615 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7616 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7617 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7618 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7619 {
7620 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7621 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7622 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7623 }
7624 
7625 /**
7626  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7627  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7628  * @gfp: allocation flags
7629  *
7630  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7631  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7632  */
7633 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7634 {
7635 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7636 }
7637 
7638 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7639 /**
7640  * DOC: Test mode
7641  *
7642  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7643  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7644  * factory programming.
7645  *
7646  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
7647  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7648  */
7649 
7650 /**
7651  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7652  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7653  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7654  *	be put into the skb
7655  *
7656  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7657  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7658  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7659  *
7660  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7661  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7662  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7663  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7664  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7665  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7666  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7667  *
7668  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7669  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7670  *
7671  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7672  */
7673 static inline struct sk_buff *
7674 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7675 {
7676 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7677 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7678 }
7679 
7680 /**
7681  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7682  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7683  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7684  *
7685  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7686  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7687  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
7688  * regardless of the return value.
7689  *
7690  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7691  */
7692 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7693 {
7694 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7695 }
7696 
7697 /**
7698  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
7699  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7700  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7701  *	be put into the skb
7702  * @gfp: allocation flags
7703  *
7704  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7705  * testmode multicast group.
7706  *
7707  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
7708  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
7709  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
7710  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
7711  * in any other way.
7712  *
7713  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
7714  * skb to send the event.
7715  *
7716  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7717  */
7718 static inline struct sk_buff *
7719 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
7720 {
7721 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7722 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
7723 					  approxlen, gfp);
7724 }
7725 
7726 /**
7727  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
7728  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7729  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
7730  * @gfp: allocation flags
7731  *
7732  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7733  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
7734  * consumes it.
7735  */
7736 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7737 {
7738 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7739 }
7740 
7741 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
7742 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
7743 #else
7744 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
7745 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
7746 #endif
7747 
7748 /**
7749  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
7750  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
7751  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
7752  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
7753  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
7754  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
7755  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
7756  *	status for a FILS connection.
7757  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7758  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
7759  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
7760  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7761  */
7762 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
7763 	const u8 *kek;
7764 	size_t kek_len;
7765 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7766 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7767 	const u8 *pmk;
7768 	size_t pmk_len;
7769 	const u8 *pmkid;
7770 };
7771 
7772 /**
7773  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7774  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7775  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7776  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7777  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7778  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7779  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7780  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7781  *	case.
7782  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7783  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7784  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7785  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7786  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7787  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7788  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7789  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7790  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7791  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7792  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7793  * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
7794  *	zero.
7795  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7796  * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
7797  *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
7798  *	connected AP info.
7799  * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
7800  *	%NULL.
7801  * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
7802  *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
7803  * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
7804  *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
7805  *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
7806  *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
7807  *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
7808  *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
7809  *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
7810  *	to be specified.
7811  * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
7812  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
7813  *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
7814  */
7815 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7816 	int status;
7817 	const u8 *req_ie;
7818 	size_t req_ie_len;
7819 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7820 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7821 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7822 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
7823 
7824 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7825 	u16 valid_links;
7826 	struct {
7827 		const u8 *addr;
7828 		const u8 *bssid;
7829 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7830 		u16 status;
7831 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7832 };
7833 
7834 /**
7835  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7836  *
7837  * @dev: network device
7838  * @params: connection response parameters
7839  * @gfp: allocation flags
7840  *
7841  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7842  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7843  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7844  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7845  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7846  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7847  */
7848 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7849 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7850 			   gfp_t gfp);
7851 
7852 /**
7853  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7854  *
7855  * @dev: network device
7856  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7857  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7858  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7859  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7860  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7861  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7862  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7863  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7864  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7865  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7866  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7867  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7868  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7869  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7870  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7871  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7872  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7873  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7874  *	case.
7875  * @gfp: allocation flags
7876  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7877  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7878  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7879  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7880  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7881  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7882  *
7883  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7884  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7885  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7886  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7887  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7888  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7889  */
7890 static inline void
7891 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7892 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7893 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7894 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7895 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7896 {
7897 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7898 
7899 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
7900 	params.status = status;
7901 	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
7902 	params.links[0].bss = bss;
7903 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
7904 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
7905 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
7906 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
7907 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
7908 
7909 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
7910 }
7911 
7912 /**
7913  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7914  *
7915  * @dev: network device
7916  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7917  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7918  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7919  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7920  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7921  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7922  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7923  *	the real status code for failures.
7924  * @gfp: allocation flags
7925  *
7926  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7927  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7928  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
7929  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7930  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7931  */
7932 static inline void
7933 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7934 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
7935 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
7936 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
7937 {
7938 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
7939 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
7940 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
7941 }
7942 
7943 /**
7944  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
7945  *
7946  * @dev: network device
7947  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7948  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7949  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7950  * @gfp: allocation flags
7951  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
7952  *
7953  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
7954  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
7955  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
7956  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
7957  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
7958  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7959  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7960  */
7961 static inline void
7962 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7963 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
7964 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7965 {
7966 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
7967 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
7968 }
7969 
7970 /**
7971  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
7972  *
7973  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7974  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7975  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7976  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7977  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
7978  * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
7979  *	Otherwise zero.
7980  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7981  * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
7982  *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
7983  * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
7984  * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
7985  *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
7986  *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
7987  * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
7988  * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
7989  *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
7990  *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
7991  */
7992 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7993 	const u8 *req_ie;
7994 	size_t req_ie_len;
7995 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7996 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7997 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7998 
7999 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8000 	u16 valid_links;
8001 	struct {
8002 		const u8 *addr;
8003 		const u8 *bssid;
8004 		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8005 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8006 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8007 };
8008 
8009 /**
8010  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8011  *
8012  * @dev: network device
8013  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8014  * @gfp: allocation flags
8015  *
8016  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8017  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8018  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8019  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8020  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8021  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8022  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8023  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8024  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8025  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8026  */
8027 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8028 		     gfp_t gfp);
8029 
8030 /**
8031  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8032  *
8033  * @dev: network device
8034  * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8035  *	in case of AP/P2P GO
8036  * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8037  * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8038  * @gfp: allocation flags
8039  *
8040  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8041  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8042  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8043  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8044  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8045  * indicate the 802.11 association.
8046  * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8047  * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8048  * associated STA/GC.
8049  */
8050 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8051 			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8052 
8053 /**
8054  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8055  *
8056  * @dev: network device
8057  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8058  * @ie_len: length of IEs
8059  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8060  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8061  * @gfp: allocation flags
8062  *
8063  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8064  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8065  */
8066 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8067 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8068 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8069 
8070 /**
8071  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8072  * @wdev: wireless device
8073  * @cookie: the request cookie
8074  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8075  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8076  *	channel
8077  * @gfp: allocation flags
8078  */
8079 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8080 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8081 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8082 
8083 /**
8084  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8085  * @wdev: wireless device
8086  * @cookie: the request cookie
8087  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8088  * @gfp: allocation flags
8089  */
8090 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8091 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8092 					gfp_t gfp);
8093 
8094 /**
8095  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8096  * @wdev: wireless device
8097  * @cookie: the requested cookie
8098  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8099  * @gfp: allocation flags
8100  */
8101 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8102 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8103 
8104 /**
8105  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8106  *
8107  * @sinfo: the station information
8108  * @gfp: allocation flags
8109  */
8110 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8111 
8112 /**
8113  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8114  * @sinfo: the station information
8115  *
8116  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8117  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8118  * the stack.)
8119  */
8120 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8121 {
8122 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8123 }
8124 
8125 /**
8126  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8127  *
8128  * @dev: the netdev
8129  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8130  * @sinfo: the station information
8131  * @gfp: allocation flags
8132  */
8133 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8134 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8135 
8136 /**
8137  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8138  * @dev: the netdev
8139  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8140  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8141  * @gfp: allocation flags
8142  */
8143 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8144 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8145 
8146 /**
8147  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8148  *
8149  * @dev: the netdev
8150  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8151  * @gfp: allocation flags
8152  */
8153 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8154 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8155 {
8156 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8157 }
8158 
8159 /**
8160  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8161  *
8162  * @dev: the netdev
8163  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8164  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8165  * @gfp: allocation flags
8166  *
8167  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8168  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8169  * for some reasons, this function is called.
8170  *
8171  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8172  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8173  */
8174 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8175 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8176 			  gfp_t gfp);
8177 
8178 /**
8179  * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8180  *
8181  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8182  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8183  * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8184  *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8185  * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8186  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8187  * @len: length of the frame data
8188  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8189  * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8190  * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8191  */
8192 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8193 	int freq;
8194 	int sig_dbm;
8195 	bool have_link_id;
8196 	u8 link_id;
8197 	const u8 *buf;
8198 	size_t len;
8199 	u32 flags;
8200 	u64 rx_tstamp;
8201 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8202 };
8203 
8204 /**
8205  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8206  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8207  * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8208  *
8209  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8210  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8211  *
8212  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8213  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8214  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8215  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8216  */
8217 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8218 			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8219 
8220 /**
8221  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8222  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8223  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8224  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8225  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8226  * @len: length of the frame data
8227  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8228  *
8229  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8230  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8231  *
8232  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8233  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8234  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8235  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8236  */
8237 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8238 					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8239 					u32 flags)
8240 {
8241 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8242 		.freq = freq,
8243 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8244 		.buf = buf,
8245 		.len = len,
8246 		.flags = flags
8247 	};
8248 
8249 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8250 }
8251 
8252 /**
8253  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8254  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8255  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8256  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8257  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8258  * @len: length of the frame data
8259  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8260  *
8261  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8262  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8263  *
8264  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8265  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8266  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8267  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8268  */
8269 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8270 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8271 				    u32 flags)
8272 {
8273 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8274 		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8275 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8276 		.buf = buf,
8277 		.len = len,
8278 		.flags = flags
8279 	};
8280 
8281 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8282 }
8283 
8284 /**
8285  * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8286  *
8287  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8288  * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8289  * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8290  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8291  * @len: length of the frame data
8292  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8293  */
8294 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8295 	u64 cookie;
8296 	u64 tx_tstamp;
8297 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8298 	const u8 *buf;
8299 	size_t len;
8300 	bool ack;
8301 };
8302 
8303 /**
8304  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8305  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8306  * @status: TX status data
8307  * @gfp: context flags
8308  *
8309  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8310  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8311  * transmission attempt with extended info.
8312  */
8313 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8314 				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8315 
8316 /**
8317  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8318  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8319  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8320  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8321  * @len: length of the frame data
8322  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8323  * @gfp: context flags
8324  *
8325  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8326  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8327  * transmission attempt.
8328  */
8329 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8330 					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8331 					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8332 {
8333 	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8334 		.cookie = cookie,
8335 		.buf = buf,
8336 		.len = len,
8337 		.ack = ack
8338 	};
8339 
8340 	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8341 }
8342 
8343 /**
8344  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8345  *                                   port frames
8346  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8347  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8348  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8349  * @len: length of the frame data
8350  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8351  * @gfp: context flags
8352  *
8353  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8354  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8355  * the transmission attempt.
8356  */
8357 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8358 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8359 				     gfp_t gfp);
8360 
8361 /**
8362  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8363  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8364  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8365  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8366  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8367  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8368  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8369  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8370  * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8371  *
8372  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8373  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8374  * control port frames over nl80211.
8375  *
8376  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8377  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8378  *
8379  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8380  */
8381 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8382 			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8383 
8384 /**
8385  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8386  * @dev: network device
8387  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8388  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8389  * @gfp: context flags
8390  *
8391  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8392  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8393  */
8394 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8395 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8396 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8397 
8398 /**
8399  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8400  * @dev: network device
8401  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8402  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8403  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8404  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8405  * @gfp: context flags
8406  */
8407 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8408 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8409 
8410 /**
8411  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8412  * @dev: network device
8413  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8414  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8415  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8416  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8417  * @gfp: context flags
8418  *
8419  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8420  * given interval is exceeded.
8421  */
8422 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8423 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8424 
8425 /**
8426  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8427  * @dev: network device
8428  * @gfp: context flags
8429  *
8430  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8431  */
8432 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8433 
8434 /**
8435  * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8436  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8437  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8438  * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8439  * @gfp: context flags
8440  *
8441  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8442  */
8443 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8444 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8445 			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8446 
8447 static inline void
8448 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8449 		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8450 		     gfp_t gfp)
8451 {
8452 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8453 }
8454 
8455 static inline void
8456 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8457 				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8458 				gfp_t gfp)
8459 {
8460 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8461 }
8462 
8463 /**
8464  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8465  * @dev: network device
8466  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8467  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8468  * @gfp: context flags
8469  *
8470  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8471  * frame.
8472  */
8473 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8474 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8475 				       gfp_t gfp);
8476 
8477 /**
8478  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8479  * @netdev: network device
8480  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8481  * @event: type of event
8482  * @gfp: context flags
8483  *
8484  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8485  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8486  * also by full-MAC drivers.
8487  */
8488 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8489 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8490 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
8491 
8492 /**
8493  * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8494  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8495  *
8496  * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8497  * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8498  */
8499 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8500 
8501 /**
8502  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8503  * @dev: network device
8504  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8505  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8506  * @gfp: allocation flags
8507  */
8508 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8509 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8510 
8511 /**
8512  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8513  * @dev: network device
8514  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8515  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8516  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8517  * @gfp: allocation flags
8518  */
8519 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8520 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8521 
8522 /**
8523  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8524  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8525  * @addr: the transmitter address
8526  * @gfp: context flags
8527  *
8528  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8529  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8530  * sender.
8531  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8532  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8533  */
8534 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8535 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8536 
8537 /**
8538  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8539  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8540  * @addr: the transmitter address
8541  * @gfp: context flags
8542  *
8543  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8544  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8545  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8546  * station to avoid event flooding.
8547  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8548  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8549  */
8550 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8551 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8552 
8553 /**
8554  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8555  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8556  * @addr: the address of the peer
8557  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8558  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8559  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8560  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8561  * @gfp: allocation flags
8562  */
8563 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8564 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8565 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8566 
8567 /**
8568  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8569  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8570  * @frame: the frame
8571  * @len: length of the frame
8572  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8573  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8574  *
8575  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8576  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8577  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8578  */
8579 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8580 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8581 
8582 /**
8583  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8584  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8585  * @frame: the frame
8586  * @len: length of the frame
8587  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8588  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8589  *
8590  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8591  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8592  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8593  */
8594 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8595 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8596 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8597 {
8598 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8599 					sig_dbm);
8600 }
8601 
8602 /**
8603  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8604  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8605  * @chandef: the channel definition
8606  * @iftype: interface type
8607  *
8608  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8609  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8610  */
8611 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8612 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8613 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8614 
8615 /**
8616  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8617  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8618  * @chandef: the channel definition
8619  * @iftype: interface type
8620  *
8621  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8622  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8623  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8624  * more permissive conditions.
8625  *
8626  * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8627  */
8628 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8629 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8630 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8631 
8632 /*
8633  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8634  * @dev: the device which switched channels
8635  * @chandef: the new channel definition
8636  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8637  * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap
8638  *
8639  * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8640  * driver context!
8641  */
8642 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8643 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8644 			       unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap);
8645 
8646 /*
8647  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8648  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
8649  * @chandef: the future channel definition
8650  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8651  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
8652  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
8653  * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap
8654  *
8655  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
8656  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
8657  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
8658  */
8659 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8660 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8661 				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
8662 				       bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap);
8663 
8664 /**
8665  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
8666  *
8667  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8668  * @band: band pointer to fill
8669  *
8670  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8671  */
8672 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
8673 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
8674 
8675 /**
8676  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
8677  *
8678  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8679  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
8680  *
8681  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8682  */
8683 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8684 					  u8 *op_class);
8685 
8686 /**
8687  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
8688  *
8689  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8690  *
8691  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
8692  */
8693 static inline u32
8694 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
8695 {
8696 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
8697 }
8698 
8699 /*
8700  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
8701  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
8702  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
8703  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
8704  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
8705  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
8706  * @gfp: allocation flags
8707  *
8708  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
8709  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
8710  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
8711  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
8712  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
8713  */
8714 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8715 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
8716 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
8717 
8718 /*
8719  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
8720  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
8721  *
8722  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
8723  */
8724 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
8725 
8726 /**
8727  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
8728  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
8729  *
8730  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
8731  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
8732  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
8733  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
8734  * is unbound from the driver.
8735  *
8736  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8737  */
8738 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
8739 
8740 /**
8741  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
8742  * @dev: the netdev to register
8743  *
8744  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8745  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
8746  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
8747  * instead as well.
8748  *
8749  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8750  */
8751 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
8752 
8753 /**
8754  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
8755  * @dev: the netdev to register
8756  *
8757  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8758  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
8759  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
8760  * usable instead as well.
8761  *
8762  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8763  */
8764 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
8765 {
8766 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
8767 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
8768 #endif
8769 }
8770 
8771 /**
8772  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
8773  * @ies: FT IEs
8774  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
8775  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
8776  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
8777  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
8778  */
8779 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
8780 	const u8 *ies;
8781 	size_t ies_len;
8782 	const u8 *target_ap;
8783 	const u8 *ric_ies;
8784 	size_t ric_ies_len;
8785 };
8786 
8787 /**
8788  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
8789  * @netdev: network device
8790  * @ft_event: IE information
8791  */
8792 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8793 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
8794 
8795 /**
8796  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
8797  * @ies: the input IE buffer
8798  * @len: the input length
8799  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
8800  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
8801  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
8802  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
8803  *
8804  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
8805  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
8806  *
8807  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
8808  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
8809  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
8810  */
8811 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
8812 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
8813 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
8814 
8815 /**
8816  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
8817  * @ies: the IE buffer
8818  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8819  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8820  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8821  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8822  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8823  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
8824  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
8825  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8826  *
8827  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8828  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8829  * split.
8830  *
8831  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8832  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8833  *
8834  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8835  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8836  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8837  *
8838  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8839  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8840  * of the buffer should be used.
8841  */
8842 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8843 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
8844 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
8845 			      size_t offset);
8846 
8847 /**
8848  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
8849  * @ies: the IE buffer
8850  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8851  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8852  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8853  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8854  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8855  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8856  *
8857  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8858  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8859  * split.
8860  *
8861  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8862  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8863  *
8864  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8865  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8866  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8867  *
8868  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8869  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8870  * of the buffer should be used.
8871  */
8872 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8873 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
8874 {
8875 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
8876 }
8877 
8878 /**
8879  * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
8880  * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
8881  * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
8882  * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
8883  *
8884  * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
8885  * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
8886  * accordingly.
8887  */
8888 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
8889 
8890 /**
8891  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
8892  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
8893  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
8894  * @gfp: allocation flags
8895  *
8896  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
8897  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
8898  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
8899  * else caused the wakeup.
8900  */
8901 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8902 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
8903 				   gfp_t gfp);
8904 
8905 /**
8906  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
8907  *
8908  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
8909  * @gfp: allocation flags
8910  *
8911  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
8912  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
8913  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
8914  */
8915 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
8916 
8917 /**
8918  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
8919  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8920  *
8921  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
8922  */
8923 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8924 
8925 /**
8926  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
8927  *
8928  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8929  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
8930  *
8931  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
8932  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
8933  * the interface combinations.
8934  */
8935 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8936 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
8937 
8938 /**
8939  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
8940  *
8941  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8942  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
8943  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
8944  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
8945  *
8946  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
8947  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
8948  * purposes.
8949  */
8950 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8951 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
8952 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
8953 					    void *data),
8954 			       void *data);
8955 
8956 /*
8957  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
8958  *
8959  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8960  * @wdev: wireless device
8961  * @gfp: context flags
8962  *
8963  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
8964  * disconnected.
8965  *
8966  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
8967  */
8968 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8969 			 gfp_t gfp);
8970 
8971 /**
8972  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
8973  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
8974  *
8975  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
8976  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
8977  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
8978  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
8979  *
8980  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
8981  * the driver while the function is running.
8982  */
8983 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8984 
8985 /**
8986  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
8987  *
8988  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8989  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8990  *
8991  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8992  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8993  */
8994 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8995 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8996 {
8997 	u8 *ft_byte;
8998 
8999 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9000 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9001 }
9002 
9003 /**
9004  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9005  *
9006  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9007  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9008  *
9009  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9010  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9011  */
9012 static inline bool
9013 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9014 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9015 {
9016 	u8 ft_byte;
9017 
9018 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9019 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9020 }
9021 
9022 /**
9023  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9024  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9025  *
9026  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9027  */
9028 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9029 
9030 /**
9031  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9032  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9033  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9034  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9035  *	 result.
9036  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9037  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9038  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9039  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9040  * @info_len: the length of the &info
9041  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9042  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9043  */
9044 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9045 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9046 	u8 inst_id;
9047 	u8 peer_inst_id;
9048 	const u8 *addr;
9049 	u8 info_len;
9050 	const u8 *info;
9051 	u64 cookie;
9052 };
9053 
9054 /**
9055  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9056  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9057  * @match: match notification parameters
9058  * @gfp: allocation flags
9059  *
9060  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9061  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9062  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9063  */
9064 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9065 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9066 
9067 /**
9068  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9069  *
9070  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9071  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9072  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9073  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9074  * @gfp: allocation flags
9075  *
9076  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9077  */
9078 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9079 				  u8 inst_id,
9080 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9081 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9082 
9083 /* ethtool helper */
9084 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9085 
9086 /**
9087  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9088  * @netdev: network device
9089  * @params: External authentication parameters
9090  * @gfp: allocation flags
9091  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9092  */
9093 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9094 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9095 				   gfp_t gfp);
9096 
9097 /**
9098  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9099  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9100  * @req: the original measurement request
9101  * @result: the result data
9102  * @gfp: allocation flags
9103  */
9104 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9105 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9106 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9107 			  gfp_t gfp);
9108 
9109 /**
9110  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9111  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9112  * @req: the original measurement request
9113  * @gfp: allocation flags
9114  *
9115  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9116  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9117  */
9118 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9119 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9120 			    gfp_t gfp);
9121 
9122 /**
9123  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9124  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9125  * @iftype: interface type
9126  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9127  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9128  *
9129  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9130  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9131  * check_swif is '1'.
9132  */
9133 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9134 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9135 
9136 
9137 /**
9138  * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9139  * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9140  * @netdev: network device
9141  * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9142  * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9143  *
9144  * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9145  */
9146 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9147 			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9148 
9149 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9150 
9151 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9152 
9153 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9154 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9155 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9156 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9157 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9158 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9159 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9160 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9161 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9162 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9163 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9164 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9165 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9166 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9167 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9168 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9169 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9170 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9171 
9172 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9173 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9174 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9175 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9176 
9177 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9178 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9179 
9180 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9181 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9182 
9183 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9184 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9185 #else
9186 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9187 ({									\
9188 	if (0)								\
9189 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9190 	0;								\
9191 })
9192 #endif
9193 
9194 /*
9195  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9196  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9197  * file/line information and a backtrace.
9198  */
9199 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9200 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9201 
9202 /**
9203  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9204  * @netdev: network device
9205  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9206  * @gfp: allocation flags
9207  */
9208 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9209 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9210 				    gfp_t gfp);
9211 
9212 /**
9213  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9214  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9215  */
9216 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9217 
9218 /**
9219  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9220  * @dev: network device
9221  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9222  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9223  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9224  */
9225 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9226 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9227 			      u64 color_bitmap);
9228 
9229 /**
9230  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9231  * @dev: network device
9232  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9233  */
9234 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9235 						       u64 color_bitmap)
9236 {
9237 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9238 					 0, color_bitmap);
9239 }
9240 
9241 /**
9242  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9243  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9244  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9245  *
9246  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9247  */
9248 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9249 						       u8 count)
9250 {
9251 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9252 					 count, 0);
9253 }
9254 
9255 /**
9256  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9257  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9258  *
9259  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9260  */
9261 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9262 {
9263 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9264 					 0, 0);
9265 }
9266 
9267 /**
9268  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9269  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9270  *
9271  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9272  */
9273 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9274 {
9275 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9276 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9277 					 0, 0);
9278 }
9279 
9280 /**
9281  * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap
9282  * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated
9283  * @chandef: channel definition
9284  *
9285  * Validate the puncturing bitmap.
9286  *
9287  * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise.
9288  */
9289 bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap,
9290 					      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9291 
9292 /**
9293  * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9294  * @dev: network device.
9295  * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9296  *
9297  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9298  * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9299  * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9300  * case disconnect instead.
9301  * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9302  */
9303 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9304 
9305 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9306 /**
9307  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9308  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9309  * @file: the file being read
9310  * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9311  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9312  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9313  * @count: read count
9314  * @ppos: read position
9315  * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9316  * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9317  */
9318 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9319 				  char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9320 				  char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9321 				  loff_t *ppos,
9322 				  ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9323 						     struct file *file,
9324 						     char *buf,
9325 						     size_t bufsize,
9326 						     void *data),
9327 				  void *data);
9328 
9329 /**
9330  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9331  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9332  * @file: the file being written to
9333  * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9334  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9335  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9336  * @count: read count
9337  * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9338  * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9339  */
9340 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9341 				   char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9342 				   const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9343 				   ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9344 						      struct file *file,
9345 						      char *buf,
9346 						      size_t count,
9347 						      void *data),
9348 				   void *data);
9349 #endif
9350 
9351 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9352